blob: da3a091b81148dc3dbc03c23a2657c33eb60626e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
William Lallemandbdd71782020-11-13 21:20:03 +01007 2020/11/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand83972542020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreauc66de522020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
1084 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
1282 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1284
1285 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1286 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1287
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001288 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1289 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1290 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1291 designed to be used with a local log server.
1292
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001293 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1294 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1295 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1296 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1297 logger consumes.
1298
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001299 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1300 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1301 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1302 used with a local log server.
1303
1304 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1305 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1306 designed to be used with a local log server.
1307
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001308 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1309 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1310 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1311 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1312
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001313 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1314 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1315 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1316 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1317 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1318
1319 <sample_size>
1320 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1321 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1322 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1323 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1324 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1325
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001326 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001328 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1329 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1330 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1331
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001332 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1333 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1334 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1335 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
1337 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001338 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1339 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1340 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1341 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1342 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1343 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001344
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001346
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001347log-send-hostname [<string>]
1348 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1349 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1350 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1351 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1352 the logs.
1353
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001354log-tag <string>
1355 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1356 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1357 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001358 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001360lua-load <file>
1361 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1362 used multiple times.
1363
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001364lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1365 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1366 variable.
1367 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1368 to "path".
1369
1370 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1371 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1372 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1373 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1374 will be checked earlier.
1375
1376 As an example by specifying the following path:
1377
1378 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1379 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1380
1381 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1382 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1383 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1384 paths if that does not exist either.
1385
1386 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1387 documentation.
1388
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001389master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001390 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1391 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1392 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001393 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001394 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1395 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001396 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1397 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1398 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1399 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1400 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001401
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001402 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001403
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001404mworker-max-reloads <number>
1405 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001406 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001407 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1408 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1409 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1410
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001411nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1413 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1414 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001415 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1416 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001417 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1418 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1419 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001420
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001421nbthread <number>
1422 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001423 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1424 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1425 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1426 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1427 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001428 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1429 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1430 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1431 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1432 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1433 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1434 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001435
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001437 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1438 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1439 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1440 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001442pp2-never-send-local
1443 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1444 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1445 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1446 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1447 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1448 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1449 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1450 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1451 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1452 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1453 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1454
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001455presetenv <name> <value>
1456 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1457 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1458 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1459 and "unsetenv".
1460
1461resetenv [<name> ...]
1462 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1463 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1464 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1465 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1466 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1467 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1468 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1469 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1470
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001471stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001472 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1473 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1474 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1475 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1476 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1477 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001478 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001479 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1480 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1481 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1482 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001483
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001484server-state-base <directory>
1485 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001486 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1487 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001488
1489server-state-file <file>
1490 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1491 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1492 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1493 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1494 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1495 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1496 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1497 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001498 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1499 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001500
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001501setenv <name> <value>
1502 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1503 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1504 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1505 and "unsetenv".
1506
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001507set-dumpable
1508 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001509 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1510 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1511 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1512 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1513 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1514 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1515 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1516 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1517 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1518 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1519 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1520 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1521 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1522 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1523 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1524 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1525 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001526
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001527ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1529 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001530 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001531 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001532 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1533 information and recommendations see e.g.
1534 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1535 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1536 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1537 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001538
1539ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1541 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1542 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1543 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1544 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001545 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1546 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1547 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001548 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001549
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001550ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1552 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1553 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1554 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1555 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1556
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001557ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1559 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1560 keyword to see available options.
1561
1562 Example:
1563 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001564 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001565
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001566ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1568 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001569 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001570 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001571 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1572 information and recommendations see e.g.
1573 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1574 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1575 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1576 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1577 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001578
1579ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1581 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1582 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1583 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1584 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1586 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1587 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1588 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001589
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001590ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1592 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1593 keyword to see available options.
1594
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001595ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1598 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001601 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1602 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1603 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1604 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1606 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1607 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1608
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001609ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1610 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1611 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001612 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001613 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001614 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1615
1616 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001617
1618 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1619 and won't try to remove them.
1620
1621 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1622
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001623ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001624 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001625 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1626 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001627
1628 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1629 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1630 optimize the startup time.
1631
1632 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1633 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1634 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1635
1636 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001637 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001638
1639 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001640 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1641
1642 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1643 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1644 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1645 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1646 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1647 bind configuration..
1648
1649 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1650 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1651 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1652 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1653 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1654 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1655 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1656 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1657
1658 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1659
1660 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1661 a cert bundle.
1662
1663 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1664 separately in several "crt".
1665
1666 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1667 since files are loading separately.
1668
1669 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1670 required to commit them.
1671
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001672 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001673 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001674
1675 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1676
1677 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1678
1679 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1680 not provided in the PEM file.
1681
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001682 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1683 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1684
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001685 The default behavior is "all".
1686
1687 Example:
1688 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1689 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1690 ssl-load-extra-files none
1691
1692 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1693
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001694ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1695 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1696 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1697 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1698
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001699ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001700 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001701 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1702 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1703 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1704 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1705 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1706 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001707 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001708
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001709stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1710 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1711 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1712 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001713 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001714 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001715
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001716 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1717 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1718 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001719
1720stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1721 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1722 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001723 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats maxconn <connections>
1726 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1727 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729uid <number>
1730 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1731 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1732 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1733 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1734
1735ulimit-n <number>
1736 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1737 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1738 option.
1739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001740unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1741 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1742
1743 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1744 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1745 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1746 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1747 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1748 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1749 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1750 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1751 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1752 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1753
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001754unsetenv [<name> ...]
1755 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1756 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1757 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1758 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1759 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1760 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1761 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763user <user name>
1764 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1765 See also "uid" and "group".
1766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001767node <name>
1768 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1769
1770 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1771 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1772 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1773 traffic.
1774
1775description <text>
1776 Add a text that describes the instance.
1777
1778 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1779 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1780 "<" and ">" characters.
1781
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178251degrees-data-file <file path>
1783 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001785
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001786 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001787 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1788
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000178951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1791 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1792 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1793
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001794 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1796
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200179751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001798 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1799 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1800
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001801 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1802 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1803
180451degrees-cache-size <number>
1805 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1806 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1807 By default, this cache is disabled.
1808
1809 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001810 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1811
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001812wurfl-data-file <file path>
1813 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1814 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1815
1816 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1817 with USE_WURFL=1.
1818
1819wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1820 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1821 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1822 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1823
1824 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1825
1826 Valid WURFL properties are:
1827 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1828
1829 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1830 device.
1831
1832 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1833 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1834
1835 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1836 particular web request.
1837
1838 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1839 used Libwurfl API version.
1840
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001841 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1842 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1843
1844 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1845 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1846
1847 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1848
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001849 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1850 with USE_WURFL=1.
1851
1852wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1853 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1854 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1855
1856 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1857 with USE_WURFL=1.
1858
1859wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1860 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1861 thus before the chroot.
1862
1863 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1864 with USE_WURFL=1.
1865
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001866wurfl-cache-size <size>
1867 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1868 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001869 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001870 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001871
1872 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1873 with USE_WURFL=1.
1874
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001875strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001876 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1877 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1878 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1879 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1880 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883-----------------------
1884
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001885busy-polling
1886 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1887 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1888 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1889 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1890 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1891 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1892 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1893 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1894 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1895 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1896 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1897 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1898 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1899 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1900 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1901 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1902 "poll" pollers.
1903
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001904 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1905 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1906 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1907
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001908max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1909 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1910 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1911 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1912 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1913 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1914 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1915 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1916 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001918maxconn <number>
1919 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1920 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1921 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001922 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1923 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1924 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1925 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001926 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1927 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1928 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1929 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1930 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1931 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001933maxconnrate <number>
1934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1941 fairness.
1942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001943maxcomprate <number>
1944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001950 default value.
1951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001952maxcompcpuusage <number>
1953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001962maxpipes <number>
1963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001970maxsessrate <number>
1971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1978 fairness.
1979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001980maxsslconn <number>
1981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001996maxsslrate <number>
1997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002008maxzlibmem <number>
2009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016noepoll
2017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020
2021nokqueue
2022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2025
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002026noevports
2027 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2028 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2029 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2030 also "nopoll".
2031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032nopoll
2033 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2034 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002036 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2037 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002038
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002039nosplice
2040 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002042 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002043 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2045 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2046 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2047 "option splice-response".
2048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002049nogetaddrinfo
2050 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2051 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2052
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002053noreuseport
2054 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2055 command line argument "-dR".
2056
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002057profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2058 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2059 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2060 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2061 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002062 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002063 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2064 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2065 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2066 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2067
2068 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2069 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2070 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2071 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2072 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002073 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2074 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2075 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2076 CLI.
2077
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002078spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002079 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2080 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2081 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2082 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2083 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2084 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002087 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002089 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2090 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2091 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2092 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2093 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002094 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2095 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002096 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2097 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2098 openssl configuration file uses:
2099 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2100
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002101ssl-mode-async
2102 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002103 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002104 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2105 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2106 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002107 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002108 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002109
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002110tune.buffers.limit <number>
2111 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2112 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2113 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2114 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2115 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002116 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002117 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2118 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2119 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2120 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2121 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2122 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2123 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2124 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2125 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2126
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002127tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2128 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2129 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2130 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2131 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2132
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002133tune.bufsize <number>
2134 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2135 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2136 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2137 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2138 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2139 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2140 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002141 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2142 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2143 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002144 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002145 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2146 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2147 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002148
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002149tune.chksize <number>
2150 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
2151 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
2152 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
2153 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
2154 checks whenever possible.
2155
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002156tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2157 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2158 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2159 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2160 this value. The default value is 1.
2161
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002162tune.fail-alloc
2163 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2164 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2165 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2166 gracefully.
2167
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002168tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2169 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2170 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2171 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2172 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2173 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2174
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002175tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2176 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2177 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2178 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2179 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2180 change it.
2181
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002182tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2183 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002184 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2185 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002186 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2187 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2188 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2189 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2190 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2191
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002192tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2193 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2194 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2195 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2196 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2197 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2198 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2199 recommended not to change this value.
2200
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002201tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2202 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2203 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2204 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2205 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2206 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2207 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2208 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2209
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002210tune.http.cookielen <number>
2211 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2212 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2213 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2214 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2215 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2216 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2217 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2218 to change this value.
2219
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002220tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002221 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2222 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002223 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002224 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002225 configuration directives too.
2226 The default value is 1024.
2227
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002228tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2229 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2230 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2231 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2232 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2233 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2234 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002235 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2236 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2237 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002238
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002239tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2240 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2241 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2242 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2243 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2244 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2245 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2246 this option to "off". The default is on.
2247
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002248tune.idletimer <timeout>
2249 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2250 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2251 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2252 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2253 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2254 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002255 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002256 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002257 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2258
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002259tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2260 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2261 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2262 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2263 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2264 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2265 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2266 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2267 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2268 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2269
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002270tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2271 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002272 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002273 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2274 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002275 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002276 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2277 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2278
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002279tune.lua.maxmem
2280 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2281 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2282 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2283 memory.
2284
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002285tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2286 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002287 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2288 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002289 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002290
2291tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2292 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2293 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2294 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2295 check servers.
2296
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002297tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2298 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2299 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2300 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002301 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002302
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002303tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002304 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2305 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2306 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2307 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2308 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2309 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2310 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2311 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2312 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2313 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002314
2315tune.maxpollevents <number>
2316 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2317 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2318 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2319 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2320 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2321
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002322tune.maxrewrite <number>
2323 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2324 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2325 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2326 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2327 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2328 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2329 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2330 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2331 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2332 bufsize.
2333
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002334tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2335 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2336 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2337 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2338 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2339 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2340 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2341 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2342 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2343 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002344 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2345 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002346 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2347 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2348 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2349 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2350 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2351 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2352 setting this parameter to 0.
2353
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002354tune.pipesize <number>
2355 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2356 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2357 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2358 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2359 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2360 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2361
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002362tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2363 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2364 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2365 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2366 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2367 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2368 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002370
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002371tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2372 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2373 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2374 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2375 default is 20.
2376
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002377tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2378tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2379 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2380 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2381 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002382 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002383 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002384 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2385 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2386
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002387tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002388 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002389 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2390 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2391 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2392 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2393
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002394tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002395 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002396 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002397 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2398 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2399 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2400
2401tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2402 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2403 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2404 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2405 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2406 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2407 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2408 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2409 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2410 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002411
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002412tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2413tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2414 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2415 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2416 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002417 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002418 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002419 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2420 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2421 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2422 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2423 notifying haproxy again.
2424
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002425tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002426 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2427 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2428 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002429 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002430 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002431 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002432 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2433 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2434 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002435 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2436 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002437
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002438tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002439 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002440 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2441 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2442 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2443 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2444 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2445
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002446tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2447 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2448 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2449 performances. This is disabled by default.
2450
2451 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2452 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2453
2454 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2455
2456 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2457
2458 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2459
2460 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2461 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2462 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2463
2464 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2465 converted.
2466
2467 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2468 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2469 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2470 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2471 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2472 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2473 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002474 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2475 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002476
2477 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2478
2479 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2480 only need this line:
2481
2482 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2483
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002484tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2485 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002486 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002487 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2488 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2489 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2490 being used for too long.
2491
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002492tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2493 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2494 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2495 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2496 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2497 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2498 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2499 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2500 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2501 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2502 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002503 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002504 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002505
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002506tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2507 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2508 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2509 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2510 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002511 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002512 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2513 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002514 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2515 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002516
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002517tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2518 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2519 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2520 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2521 1000 entries.
2522
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002523tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2524 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2525 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2526 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002528tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002529tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002530tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2531tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2532tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002533 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2534 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2535 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2536 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2537 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2538 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2539 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2540 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002541
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002542 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2543 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2544 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2545 all available space is consumed.
2546 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2547 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2548 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002549
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002550tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2551 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002552 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002553 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002554 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002555 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2556
2557tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2558 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2559 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002560 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2561 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025633.3. Debugging
2564--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002565
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002566quiet
2567 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2568 line argument "-q".
2569
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002570zero-warning
2571 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2572 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2573 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2574 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2575 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2576 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2577
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025793.4. Userlists
2580--------------
2581It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2582http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2583it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2584
2585userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002586 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002587 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2588
2589group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002590 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002591 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2592 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2593
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002594user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2595 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002596 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2597 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002598 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2599 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2600 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2601 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002602
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002603 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2604 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2605 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2606 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2607 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2608 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2609 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2610 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2611 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002612
2613 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002614 userlist L1
2615 group G1 users tiger,scott
2616 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002618 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2619 user scott insecure-password elgato
2620 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002622 userlist L2
2623 group G1
2624 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002625
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002626 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2627 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2628 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002629
2630 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002631
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002632
26333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002634----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002635It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2636several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2637instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2638values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2639automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2640In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2641using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2642tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2643reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2644Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2645that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2646each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002647
2648peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002649 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002650 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2651
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002652bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2653 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2654 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2655
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002656disabled
2657 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2658 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2659 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2660
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002661default-bind [param*]
2662 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2663
2664default-server [param*]
2665 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2666
2667 Arguments:
2668 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2669 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2670 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2671 details.
2672
2673
2674 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2675
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002676enable
2677 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2678
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002679log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2680 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2681 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2682 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2683 more details.
2684
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002685peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002686 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2687 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002688 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2689 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2690 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2691 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2692 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002693
2694 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2695 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2696
2697 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002698 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2699 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2700 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002702 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2703 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002704
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002705 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2706 "server" keyword explanation below).
2707
2708server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002709 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002710 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2711 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2712 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2713 of this "peers" section).
2714 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2715
2716
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002717 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002718 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002719 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002720 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2721 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2722 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002723
2724 backend mybackend
2725 mode tcp
2726 balance roundrobin
2727 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2728 stick on src
2729
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002730 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2731 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002732
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002733 Example:
2734 peers mypeers
2735 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2736 default-server ssl verify none
2737 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2738 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002739
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002740
2741table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2742 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2743
2744 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2745 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002746 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002747 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2748 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2749 "stick-table" keyword).
2750
2751 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2752 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2753 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2754 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2755 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2756 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2757 of the stick-table name as follows:
2758
2759 peers mypeers
2760 peer A ...
2761 peer B ...
2762 table t1 ...
2763
2764 frontend fe1
2765 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2766
2767 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2768 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2769
2770 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2771 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2772 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2773 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2774 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2775 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2776 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2777
2778 peers mypeers
2779 peer A ...
2780 peer B ...
2781 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2782
2783 backend t1
2784 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2785
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002786 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002787 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2788 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2789
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027903.6. Mailers
2791------------
2792It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2793If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2794in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2795
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002796mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002797 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2798 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2799
2800mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2801 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2802
2803 Example:
2804 mailers mymailers
2805 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2806 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2807
2808 backend mybackend
2809 mode tcp
2810 balance roundrobin
2811
2812 email-alert mailers mymailers
2813 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2814 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2815
2816 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2817 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2818
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002819timeout mail <time>
2820 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2821 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2822 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2823 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2824
2825 Example:
2826 mailers mymailers
2827 timeout mail 20s
2828 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002829
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028303.7. Programs
2831-------------
2832In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2833master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2834managed the same way as the workers.
2835
2836During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2837sequence as a worker:
2838
2839 - the master is re-executed
2840 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2841 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2842 instance of the program
2843
2844During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2845
2846program <name>
2847 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2848 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2849 the management guide).
2850
2851command <command> [arguments*]
2852 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2853 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2854 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2855 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2856
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002857user <user name>
2858 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2859 See also "group".
2860
2861group <group name>
2862 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2863 See also "user".
2864
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002865option start-on-reload
2866no option start-on-reload
2867 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2868 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2869 program section.
2870
2871
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028723.8. HTTP-errors
2873----------------
2874
2875It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2876imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2877several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2878
2879http-errors <name>
2880 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2881 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2882
2883errorfile <code> <file>
2884 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2885
2886 Arguments :
2887 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002888 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2889 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002890
2891 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2892 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2893 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2894 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2895 before any chroot is performed.
2896
2897 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2898
2899 Example:
2900 http-errors website-1
2901 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2902 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2903 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2904
2905 http-errors website-2
2906 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2907 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2908 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2909
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029103.9. Rings
2911----------
2912
2913It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2914servers or traces.
2915
2916ring <ringname>
2917 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2918
2919description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002920 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002921 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2922
2923format <format>
2924 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2925
2926 Arguments:
2927 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2928 one of the following :
2929
2930 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2931 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2932 designed to be used with a local log server.
2933
2934 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2935 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2936 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2937 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2938 is the default.
2939
2940 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2941 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2942
2943 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2944 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2945
2946 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2947 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2948 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2949 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2950 logger consumes.
2951
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002952 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2953 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2954 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2955 with a local log server.
2956
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002957 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2958 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2959 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2960 used with a local log server.
2961
2962maxlen <length>
2963 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2964 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2965 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2966
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002967server <name> <address> [param*]
2968 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2969 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2970 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2971 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2972 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2973 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2974 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2975 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2976 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002977 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2978 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002979
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002980size <size>
2981 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2982 set to BUFSIZE.
2983
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002984timeout connect <timeout>
2985 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2986
2987 Arguments :
2988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2990 as explained at the top of this document.
2991
2992timeout server <timeout>
2993 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2994
2995 Arguments :
2996 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2997 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2998 as explained at the top of this document.
2999
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003000 Example:
3001 global
3002 log ring@myring local7
3003
3004 ring myring
3005 description "My local buffer"
3006 format rfc3164
3007 maxlen 1200
3008 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003009 timeout connect 5s
3010 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003011 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003012
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030133.10. Log forwarding
3014-------------------
3015
3016It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3017haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3018
3019log-forward <name>
3020 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3021
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003022backlog <conns>
3023 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3024 on connections accept.
3025
3026bind <addr> [param*]
3027 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003028 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3029 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3030 syslog protocol over TCP.
3031 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003032 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3033
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003034dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003035 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3036 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3037 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3038 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003039 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003040
3041log global
3042log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3043 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3044 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3045 documentation.
3046 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3047 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3048 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3049 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3050 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3051
3052 Example:
3053 global
3054 log stderr format iso local7
3055
3056 ring myring
3057 description "My local buffer"
3058 format rfc5424
3059 maxlen 1200
3060 size 32764
3061 timeout connect 5s
3062 timeout server 10s
3063 # syslog tcp server
3064 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3065
3066 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003067 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3068 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003069 # all messages on stderr
3070 log global
3071 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3072 log ring@myring local0
3073 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3074 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3075 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3076 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3077 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003078
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003079maxconn <conns>
3080 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3081 10 is the default.
3082
3083timeout client <timeout>
3084 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030864. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003087----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003088
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003089Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003090 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003091 - frontend <name>
3092 - backend <name>
3093 - listen <name>
3094
3095A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3096its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3097section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003098section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003099
3100A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3101connections.
3102
3103A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3104to forward incoming connections.
3105
3106A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3107parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3110'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3111case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3112
3113Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3114logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3115proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3116However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3117name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3118
3119Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3120and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003121bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3123modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3124arbitrary criteria.
3125
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003126In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3127a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003128the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003129
3130 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3131 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3132 between responses and new requests.
3133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003134 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3135 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3136 client-facing connection remains open.
3137
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003138 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3139 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003140
3141The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3142frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3143following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003145
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003146 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003147
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003148 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3149 ----+-----+-----+----
3150 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3151 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003152 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3153 ----+-----+-----+----
3154 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3159--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003161The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3162limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3163they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3164limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003165marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003166option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003167and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3168with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3169specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003171
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003172 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3173------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3174acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003175backlog X X X -
3176balance X - X X
3177bind - X X -
3178bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003179capture cookie - X X -
3180capture request header - X X -
3181capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003182clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3183clitcpka-idle X X X -
3184clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003185compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003186cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003187declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003188default-server X - X X
3189default_backend X X X -
3190description - X X X
3191disabled X X X X
3192dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003193email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003194email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003195email-alert mailers X X X X
3196email-alert myhostname X X X X
3197email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003198enabled X X X X
3199errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003200errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003201errorloc X X X X
3202errorloc302 X X X X
3203-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3204errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003205force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003206filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003207fullconn X - X X
3208grace X X X X
3209hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003210http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003211http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003212http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003213http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003214http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003215http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003216http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003217http-check set-var X - X X
3218http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003219http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003220http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003221http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003222http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003223http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003224id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003225ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003226load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003227log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003228log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003229log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003230log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003231max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003232maxconn X X X -
3233mode X X X X
3234monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003235monitor-uri X X X -
3236option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3237option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3238option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3239option allbackups (*) X - X X
3240option checkcache (*) X - X X
3241option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3242option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003243option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003244option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3245option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003246-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3247option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003248option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3249option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003250option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003251option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003252option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003253option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003254option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003255option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3256option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3257option httpchk X - X X
3258option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003259option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003260option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003261option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003262option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003263option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003264option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3265option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3266option logasap (*) X X X -
3267option mysql-check X - X X
3268option nolinger (*) X X X X
3269option originalto X X X X
3270option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003271option pgsql-check X - X X
3272option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003273option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003274option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003275option smtpchk X - X X
3276option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3277option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3278option splice-request (*) X X X X
3279option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003280option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3282option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3283-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003284option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003285option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3286option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3287option tcpka X X X X
3288option tcplog X X X X
3289option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003290external-check command X - X X
3291external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003292persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3293rate-limit sessions X X X -
3294redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003295-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003296retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003297retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003298server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003299server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003300server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003301source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003302srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3303srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3304srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003305stats admin - X X X
3306stats auth X X X X
3307stats enable X X X X
3308stats hide-version X X X X
3309stats http-request - X X X
3310stats realm X X X X
3311stats refresh X X X X
3312stats scope X X X X
3313stats show-desc X X X X
3314stats show-legends X X X X
3315stats show-node X X X X
3316stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003317-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3318stick match - - X X
3319stick on - - X X
3320stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003321stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003322stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003323tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003324tcp-check connect X - X X
3325tcp-check expect X - X X
3326tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003327tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003328tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003329tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003330tcp-check set-var X - X X
3331tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003332tcp-request connection - X X -
3333tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003334tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003335tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003336tcp-response content - - X X
3337tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003338timeout check X - X X
3339timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003340timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003341timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003342timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3343timeout http-request X X X X
3344timeout queue X - X X
3345timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003346timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003347timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003348timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003349transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003350unique-id-format X X X -
3351unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003352use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003353use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003354use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003355------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3356 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3360---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361
3362This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3363
3364
3365acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3366 Declare or complete an access list.
3367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 no | yes | yes | yes
3369 Example:
3370 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3371 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3372 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003374 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003375
3376
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003377backlog <conns>
3378 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3380 yes | yes | yes | no
3381 Arguments :
3382 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3383 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003384 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003385
3386 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3387 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3388 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3389 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3390 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3391 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3392 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3393 backlog parameter.
3394
3395 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3396 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3397 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3398
3399 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3400
3401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003402balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003403balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3406 yes | no | yes | yes
3407 Arguments :
3408 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3409 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3410 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3411 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3412
3413 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3414 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3415 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3416 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003417 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003418 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003419 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3420 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3421 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3422 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3423 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3424 it, so that you don't worry.
3425
3426 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3427 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3428 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3429 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3430 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3431 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3432 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3433 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003435 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3436 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3437 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3438 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3439 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3440 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3441 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003442 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3443 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3444 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003445
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003446 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003447 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003448 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3449 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003450 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003451 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3452 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3453 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3454 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3455 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003456 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3457 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3458 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3459 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3460 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3461 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3464 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3465 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3466 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3467 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3468 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3469 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3470 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003471 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003473 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3474 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3475 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003477 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3478 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3479 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3480 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3481 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3482 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3483 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3484 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3485 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3486 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3487 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3488 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003490 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003491 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3492 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3493 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3494 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3495 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3496 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3497 URIs start with a leading "/".
3498
3499 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3500 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3501 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3502 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3503
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003504 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3505 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3506 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3507 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003510 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3511
3512 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003513 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3514 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003515 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3516 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3517 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3518 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003519 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003520 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3521 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003522
3523 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3524 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3525 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3526 server will receive the request.
3527
3528 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3529 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3530 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3531 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3532 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003533 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3534 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3535 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003537 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3538 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3539 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3540 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3541 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003542
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003543 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003544 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3545 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3546 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3547
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003548 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3549 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3550 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3551
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003552 random
3553 random(<draws>)
3554 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003555 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3556 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3557 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3558 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003559 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3560 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3561 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3562 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3563 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3564 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3565 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3566 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3567 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3568 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3569 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3570 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3571 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3572 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3573 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3574 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3575 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3576 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3577 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3578 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003579
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003580 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003581 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003582 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3583 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3584 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3585 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3586 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3587 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003588 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003589 used instead.
3590
3591 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3592 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3593 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3594 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3595
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003596 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3597 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3598 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003600 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003603 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3604 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003605
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003606 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3607 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3608 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003610 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003611 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003612 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3613 NTLM relies on.
3614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615 Examples :
3616 balance roundrobin
3617 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003618 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003619 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3620 balance hdr(host)
3621 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003622
3623 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3624 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003626 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003627 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3628 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3629 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003630 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003631
3632 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3633 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3634 defaults to 16 kB.
3635
3636 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3637 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3638
3639 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3640 Round Robin.
3641
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003642 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003643 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3644 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3645 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3646
3647 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3648
3649 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003650 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003651 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3652 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3653 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003655 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656
3657
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003658bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3659bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 no | yes | yes | no
3663 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003664 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3665 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3666 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3667 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003668 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003669 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3670 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3671 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3672 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3673 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3674 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003675 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003676 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3677 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003678 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003679 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3680 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003681 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003682 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3683 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003684 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003685 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3686 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3687 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3688 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3689 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3690 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3691 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003692 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3693 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3694 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003695 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3696 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3697 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3698 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003699 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3700 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3701 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003702
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003703 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3704 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003705 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3706 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3707 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003708 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3709 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3710 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3711 the range.
3712
3713 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3714 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3715 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3716 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3717 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3718 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3719 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003720 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003721 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003723 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003724 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003725 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3726 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3727 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3728 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3729 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3730 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3731
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003732 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3733 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3734 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3735 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3738 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3739 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3740 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3741 in a frontend.
3742
3743 Example :
3744 listen http_proxy
3745 bind :80,:443
3746 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003747 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003748
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003749 listen http_https_proxy
3750 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003751 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003752
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003753 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3754 bind ipv6@:80
3755 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3756 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3757
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003758 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003759 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003760
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003761 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3762 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3763 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3764 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3765 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3766
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003767 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003768 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003769
3770
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003771bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003772 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | yes | yes | yes
3775 Arguments :
3776 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3777 may be used to override a default value.
3778
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003779 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003780 option may be combined with other numbers.
3781
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003782 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003783 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3784 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3785 missing from all processes.
3786
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003787 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003788 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003789 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3790 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3791 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3792 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3793 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003794 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003795
3796 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3797 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3798 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3799 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3800 and 'even' instances.
3801
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003802 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3803 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3804 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3805 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003806
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003807 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3808 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3809
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003810 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3811 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3812 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3813
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003814 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3815 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3816
3817 Example :
3818 listen app_ip1
3819 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003820 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003821
3822 listen app_ip2
3823 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003824 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003825
3826 listen management
3827 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003828 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003829
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003830 listen management
3831 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3832 bind-process 1-4
3833
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003834 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
3836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003837capture cookie <name> len <length>
3838 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 no | yes | yes | no
3841 Arguments :
3842 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3843 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3844 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3845 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003846 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003847
3848 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3849 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3850 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3851 right if it exceeds <length>.
3852
3853 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3854 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3855 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3856 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3857
3858 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3859 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3860 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3861
3862 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3863 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3864 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003865 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3866 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3867 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868
3869 Example:
3870 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3871
3872 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003873 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
3875
3876capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003877 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 no | yes | yes | no
3880 Arguments :
3881 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003882 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003883 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3884 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3885 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3886
3887 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3888 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3889 it exceeds <length>.
3890
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003891 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003892 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3893 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003894 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3895 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3896 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3897 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003898 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003899 environments to find where the request came from.
3900
3901 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3902 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3903 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3904 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003905
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003906 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3907 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3908 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3909 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3910 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003911
3912 Example:
3913 capture request header Host len 15
3914 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003915 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003917 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918 about logging.
3919
3920
3921capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003922 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3924 no | yes | yes | no
3925 Arguments :
3926 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003927 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003928 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3929 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3930 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3931
3932 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3933 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3934 it exceeds <length>.
3935
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003936 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3938 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3939 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003940 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3941 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3942 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3943 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003944
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003945 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3946 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3947 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3948 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3949 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
3951 Example:
3952 capture response header Content-length len 9
3953 capture response header Location len 15
3954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003955 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956 about logging.
3957
3958
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003959clitcpka-cnt <count>
3960 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3961 the connection on the client side.
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | yes | yes | no
3964 Arguments :
3965 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3966
3967 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3968 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003969 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3970 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003971
3972 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3973
3974
3975clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3976 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3977 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3978 client side.
3979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3980 yes | yes | yes | no
3981 Arguments :
3982 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3983 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3984 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3985 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3986
3987 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3988 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003989 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3990 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003991
3992 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3993
3994
3995clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3996 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3998 yes | yes | yes | no
3999 Arguments :
4000 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4001 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4002 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4003 document.
4004
4005 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4006 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004007 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4008 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004009
4010 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4011
4012
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004013compression algo <algorithm> ...
4014compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004015compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004016 Enable HTTP compression.
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | yes
4019 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004020 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4021 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4022 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4023
4024 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004025 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4026 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4027 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004028
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004029 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004030 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004031
4032 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4033 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4034 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4035 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4036 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004037 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004038
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004039 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4040 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4041 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4042 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4043 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4044 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4045 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004046 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004047
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004048 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004049 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004050 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4051 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4052 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4053 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4054 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004055
4056 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4057 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4058 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4059 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4060 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004061 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4062 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4063 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4064 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4065 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004066 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4067 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004068
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004069 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004070 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4071 "Accept-Encoding" header
4072 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004073 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004074 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4075 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4076 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4077 "multipart"
4078 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4079 header
4080 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4081 and later
4082 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4083 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004084 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004085
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004086 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004087
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004088 Examples :
4089 compression algo gzip
4090 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004092
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004093cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004094 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4095 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004096 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004097 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 yes | no | yes | yes
4100 Arguments :
4101 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4102 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4103 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4104 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4105 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4106 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004107 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4109 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4110
4111 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4112 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4113 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4114 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4115 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4116 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004117 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4118 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004119 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004120 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4121 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
4123 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004124 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004125
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004126 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004127 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004128 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004129 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004130 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4131 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4132 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4133 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4134 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4135 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4136 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137
4138 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4139 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4140 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4141 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4142 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4143 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4144 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4145 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4146 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004147 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004148 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4149 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4150 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004152 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4153 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4154 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004155 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4156 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4157 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4158 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004159 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4160 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4161 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
4163 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4164 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4165 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4166 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4167 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4168 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4169 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4170 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4171 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4172
4173 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4174 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4175 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4176 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4177 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4178 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4179 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4180 persistence cookie in the cache.
4181 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4182
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004183 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4184 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4185 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4186 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4187 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004188 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004189 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4190 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4191 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4192 they logout.
4193
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004194 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4195 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4196 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4197 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4198
4199 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4200 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4201 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4202 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4203 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4204 this attribute.
4205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004206 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004207 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004208 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4209 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4210 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4211 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4212 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4213 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004214
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004215 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4216 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4217 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4218 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4219 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4220 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4221 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4222 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004223 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004224 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4225 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4226 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4227 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4228 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4229 the site.
4230
4231 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4232 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4233 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4234 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4235 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4236 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4237 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4238 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4239 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4240 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4241 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4242 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4243 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004244 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004245 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4246 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4247
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004248 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4249 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4250 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4251 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4252 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4253 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4254
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004255 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4256 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4257 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4258 repeated.
4259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004260 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4261 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4262 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4263 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004265 Examples :
4266 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4267 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4268 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004269 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004270
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004271 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004273
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004274declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4275 Declares a capture slot.
4276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 no | yes | yes | no
4278 Arguments:
4279 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4280
4281 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4282 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4283 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4284 for use in the response.
4285
4286 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004287 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004288 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4289
4290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004291default-server [param*]
4292 Change default options for a server in a backend
4293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 yes | no | yes | yes
4295 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004296 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4297 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4298 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4299 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004300
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004301 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004302 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4303
4304 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004305
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004307default_backend <backend>
4308 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 yes | yes | yes | no
4311 Arguments :
4312 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4313
4314 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4315 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4316 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4317 will catch all undetermined requests.
4318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004319 Example :
4320
4321 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4322 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4323 default_backend dynamic
4324
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004325 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004328description <string>
4329 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 no | yes | yes | yes
4332 Arguments : string
4333
4334 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4335 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4336 it describes.
4337 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4338
4339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004340disabled
4341 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4343 yes | yes | yes | yes
4344 Arguments : none
4345
4346 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4347 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4348 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4349 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4350 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4351 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4352 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4353
4354 See also : "enabled"
4355
4356
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004357dispatch <address>:<port>
4358 Set a default server address
4359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004362
4363 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4364 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4365 during start-up.
4366
4367 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4368 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4369 possible with normal servers.
4370
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004371 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004372 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4373 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4374 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4375 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4376
4377 See also : "server"
4378
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004379
4380dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4381 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4383 yes | no | yes | yes
4384 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4385
4386 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004387 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004388 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4389 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004390 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004391 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393enabled
4394 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | yes
4397 Arguments : none
4398
4399 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4400 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4401
4402 See also : "disabled"
4403
4404
4405errorfile <code> <file>
4406 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 yes | yes | yes | yes
4409 Arguments :
4410 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004411 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004412 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
4414 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004415 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004416 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004417 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4418 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004419
4420 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4421 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4422 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4423
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004424 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4425
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004426 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4427 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4428 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4429 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4430 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4431 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4432 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4433 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4434 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4437 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4438 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004439 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004440 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4441
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004442 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004443
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004444 Example :
4445 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004446 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004447 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4448 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004450
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004451errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4452 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4453 section.
4454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4455 yes | yes | yes | yes
4456 Arguments :
4457 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4458
4459 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004460 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004461 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004462
4463 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4464 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4465 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4466 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4467 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004468 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004469 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4470
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004471 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4472 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004473
4474 Example :
4475 errorfiles generic
4476 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4477
4478
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004479errorloc <code> <url>
4480errorloc302 <code> <url>
4481 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 yes | yes | yes | yes
4484 Arguments :
4485 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004486 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004487 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004488
4489 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4490 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4491 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4492 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004493 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494
4495 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4496 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4497 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4498
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004499 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4500
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004501 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4502 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4503 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4504 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004505 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004506 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4507 request.
4508
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004509 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004510
4511
4512errorloc303 <code> <url>
4513 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | yes | yes | yes
4516 Arguments :
4517 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004518 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004519 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004520
4521 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4522 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4523 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4524 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004525 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004526
4527 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4528 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4529 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4530
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004531 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4532
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004533 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4534 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4535 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4536 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004537 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004538
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004539 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004540
4541
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004542email-alert from <emailaddr>
4543 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4546 yes | yes | yes | yes
4547
4548 Arguments :
4549
4550 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4551
4552 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4553 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4554
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004555 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004556 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4557 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004558
4559
4560email-alert level <level>
4561 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4562 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4564 yes | yes | yes | yes
4565
4566 Arguments :
4567
4568 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4569 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4570 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4571
4572 By default level is alert
4573
4574 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4575 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4576 for the proxy.
4577
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004578 Alerts are sent when :
4579
4580 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4581 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4582 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4583 is notice or lower
4584 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4585 and a health check status update occurs
4586
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004587 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4588 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004589 section 3.6 about mailers.
4590
4591
4592email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4593 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | yes | yes | yes
4596
4597 Arguments :
4598
4599 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4600
4601 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4602 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4603
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004604 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4605 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004606
4607
4608email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4609 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4610 mailers.
4611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | yes | yes | yes
4613
4614 Arguments :
4615
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004616 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004617
4618 By default the systems hostname is used.
4619
4620 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4621 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4622 for the proxy.
4623
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004624 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4625 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004626
4627
4628email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004629 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004630 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 yes | yes | yes | yes
4633
4634 Arguments :
4635
4636 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4637
4638 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4639 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4640
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004641 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004642 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4643
4644
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004645force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4646 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004648 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004649
4650 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4651 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4652 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4653 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4654 marked down for maintenance operations.
4655
4656 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4657 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4658 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4659 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4660 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4661 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4662 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4663 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4664 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4665
4666 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4667 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4668 is used.
4669
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004670 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004671 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004672
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004673
4674filter <name> [param*]
4675 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 no | yes | yes | yes
4678 Arguments :
4679 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4680 referenced in section 9.
4681
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004682 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004683 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004684 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4685 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004686
4687 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4688 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4689
4690 Example:
4691 listen
4692 bind *:80
4693
4694 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4695 filter compression
4696 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4697
4698 compression algo gzip
4699 compression offload
4700
4701 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4702
4703 See also : section 9.
4704
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004706fullconn <conns>
4707 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | no | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4712 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4713
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004714 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004715 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004716 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004717 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4718 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4719 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4720 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4721 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004722 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004724 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4725 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004726 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4727 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4728 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730 Example :
4731 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4732 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4733 # connections.
4734 backend dynamic
4735 fullconn 10000
4736 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4737 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4738
4739 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4740
4741
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004742grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004743 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004745 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004746 Arguments :
4747 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4748 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4749 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4750
4751 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4752 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004753 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4755
4756 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4757 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4758 simplify it.
4759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004760
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004761hash-balance-factor <factor>
4762 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | no | no | yes
4765 Arguments :
4766 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4767 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004768 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004769
4770 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4771 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4772 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4773 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4774 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4775 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4776 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4777
4778 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4779 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4780 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4781 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4782 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4783
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004784 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4785 consistent hashing mechanism.
4786
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004787 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4788
4789
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004790hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004791 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | yes | yes
4794 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004795 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4796 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004797
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004798 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4799 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4800 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4801 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4802 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4803 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4804 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4805 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4806 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4807 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004808
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004809 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4810 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4811 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4812 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4813 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4814 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4815 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4816 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4817 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4818 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4819 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4820 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4821 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004822 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4823 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004824
4825 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4826
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004827 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004828 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4829 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4830 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004831 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4832 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4833 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004834
4835 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4836 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004837 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4838 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4839 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4840 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4841
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004842 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4843 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4844 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4845 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4846 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4847 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4848 parameter.
4849
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004850 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4851 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4852 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4853 used on strings.
4854
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004855 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4856
4857 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4858 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4859 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4860 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4861 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4862 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4863 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4864 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4865 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4866 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4867 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4868 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004869
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004870 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4871 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4872 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004873
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004874 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004875
4876
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004877http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4878 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4879 ones).
4880
4881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 no | yes | yes | yes
4883
4884 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4885 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4886 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4887 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4888 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4889 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4890
4891 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4892 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4893 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4894
4895 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4896 below.
4897
4898 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4899 instance.
4900
4901 Example:
4902 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4903 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4904 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4905
4906http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4907
4908 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4909 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4910 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4911 example, or to pass some internal information.
4912 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4913 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4914 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4915
4916http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4917
4918 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4919 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4920
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004921http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004922
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004923 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4924 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4925 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4926 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4927 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004928
4929http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4933
4934 Example:
4935 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4936
4937 # applied to:
4938 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4939
4940 # outputs:
4941 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4942
4943 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4944
4945http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4946 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4947
4948 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4949
4950 Example:
4951 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4952
4953 # applied to:
4954 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4955
4956 # outputs:
4957 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4958
4959http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4960
4961 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4962 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4963 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4964
4965http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4966 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4967
4968 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4969 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4970 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4971 fallback.
4972
4973 Example:
4974 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4975 http-response set-status 431
4976 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4977 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4978
4979http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4980
4981 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4982 inline.
4983
4984 Arguments:
4985 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4986 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4987 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4988 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4989 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4990 (request and response)
4991 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4992 processing
4993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4994 processing
4995 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4996 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4997 and '_'.
4998
4999 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5000 followed by some converters.
5001
5002 Example:
5003 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5004
5005http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5006
5007 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5008 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5009 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5010 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5011 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005012 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005013 processing.
5014
5015 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5016 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005017 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005018 rules evaluation.
5019
5020http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5021
5022 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5023 details about <var-name>.
5024
5025 Example:
5026 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5027
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005028
5029http-check comment <string>
5030 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5031 it fails.
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005035 Arguments :
5036 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5037 rule fails.
5038
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005039 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5040 user-friendly error reporting.
5041
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005042 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005043 "http-check expect".
5044
5045
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005046http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5047 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005048 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005049 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5051 yes | no | yes | yes
5052
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005053 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005054 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5055
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005056 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005057 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005058
5059 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5060 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5061 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5062 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5063
5064 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5065
5066 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5067
5068 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5069
5070 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5071
5072 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5073
5074 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5075 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5076 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5077 is used.
5078
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005079 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5080 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5081 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5082 haproxy -vv.
5083
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005084 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5085
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005086 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5087 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5088 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5089 different ports or with different servers.
5090
5091 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5092 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5093 the port with a "http-check connect".
5094
5095 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5096 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5097 do.
5098
5099 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5100 unset-var or comment rules.
5101
5102 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005103 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5104 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5105 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5106 option httpchk
5107
5108 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005109 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005110 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005111 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005112 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005113 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005114
5115 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5116
5117 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005118
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005120http-check disable-on-404
5121 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005123 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005124 Arguments : none
5125
5126 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5127 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5128 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5129 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5130 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5131 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5132 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5133 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005134 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5135 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
5136 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
5137
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005138 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005139
5140
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005141http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005142 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5143 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5144 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005145 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005147 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005149 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005150 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5151
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005152 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5153 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5154 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5155 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5156 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5157 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5158 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5159 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5160 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5161 result is always conclusive.
5162
5163 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5164 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5165 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005166 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5167 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
5168 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
5169 example 404 with disable-on-404
5170 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5171 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5172 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173
5174 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5175 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005176 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
5177 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5178 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5179 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5180 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5181 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005182
5183 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5184 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005185 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5186 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5187 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5188 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005189 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5190
5191 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5192 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5193 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5194 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5195
5196 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5197 informational message reported in logs if an error
5198 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5199 log-format string.
5200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005201 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005202 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5203 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005204 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5205 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5206 details on the supported keywords.
5207
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005208 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5209 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5210 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5211 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005212
5213 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5214 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5215 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5216 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5217 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5218
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005219 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5220 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5221 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5222 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5223 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5224 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5225 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005226
5227 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005228 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005229 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5230 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5231 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5232 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5233
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005234 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5235 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005236 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5237 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5238 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5239 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5240 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5241 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5242 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5243 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005244 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5245 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5246 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5247 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5248 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5249 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5250 insensitive on the header names.
5251
5252 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5253 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5254 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5255 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5256 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5257 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005258
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005259 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005260 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005261 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5262 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5263 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5264 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5265 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005266 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005267 trace).
5268
5269 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005271 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5272 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5273 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5274 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5275 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005276 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005277
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005278 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5279 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5280 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5281 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5282 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5283 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5284
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005285 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5286 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5287 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5288 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5289 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5290 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5291 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5292 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5293
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005294 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5295 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5296 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5297 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5298 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005299
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005300 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5301 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5302
5303 Examples :
5304 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005305 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005306
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005307 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5308 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5309
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005310 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005311 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005312
5313 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005314 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005315
5316 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005317 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005318
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005319 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005320 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005321
5322
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005323http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005324 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5325 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005326 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5327 health checks.
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005331 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5332
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005333 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5334 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5335 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5336 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5337 to invent non-standard ones.
5338
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005339 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5340 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5341 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5342 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5343
5344 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5345 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5346 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5347 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005348
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005349 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005350 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005351 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005352 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5353 to add it.
5354
5355 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5356 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5357 to the log-format rules.
5358
5359 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5360 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5361 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005362
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005363 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5364 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5365 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5366 request.
5367
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005368 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5369 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5370 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005371 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5372 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5373 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5374 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005375 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005376 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005377 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5378
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005379 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5380 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005381 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5382 so, it will be ignored.
5383
5384 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5385 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5386 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5387 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5388 configured request authority.
5389
5390 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5391 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005392
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005393 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005394
5395
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005396http-check send-state
5397 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5399 yes | no | yes | yes
5400 Arguments : none
5401
5402 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5403 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5404 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5405 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5406 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5407
5408 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5409 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5410 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5411 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5412 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005413 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5414 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5415 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5416
5417 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5418 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5419 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5420
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005421 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5422 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5423 checked in multiple backends.
5424
5425 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5426 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5427
5428 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5429 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5430 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5431 one fails.
5432
5433 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5434 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5435 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5436
5437 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5438 server's queue.
5439
5440 Example of a header received by the application server :
5441 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5442 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5443
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005444 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5445 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005446
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005447
5448http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 yes | no | yes | yes
5452
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005453 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5455 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5456 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5457 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5458 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5459 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5460 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5461 and '-'.
5462
5463 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5464
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005465 Examples :
5466 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468
5469http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | no | yes | yes
5473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005474 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005475 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5476 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5477 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5478 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5479 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5480 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5481 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5482 and '-'.
5483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005484 Examples :
5485 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005487
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005488http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5489 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5490 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5491 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5492 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | yes
5495 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005496 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005497 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005498 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5499 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005500
5501 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5502 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5503 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5504 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5505
5506 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5507 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5508 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5509 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5510
5511 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5512 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5513 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5514 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5515 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5516 chroot is performed.
5517
5518 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5519 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5520 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5521 considered.
5522
5523 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5524 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5525 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5526 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5527 considered as a raw string.
5528
5529 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5530 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5531 "content-type".
5532
5533 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5534 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5535 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5536 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5537 evaluated as a log-format string.
5538
5539 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5540 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5541 argument to "content-type".
5542
5543 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5544 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5545 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5546 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5547
5548 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5549 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5550 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5551 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5552 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5553 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5554 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5555 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5556
5557 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5558 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5559 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5560
5561 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5562 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5563
5564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005565http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005566 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5567
5568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5569 no | yes | yes | yes
5570
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005571 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5572 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5573 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5574 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5575 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005577 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5578 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005580 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005582 Example:
5583 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5584 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5585 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587 http-request allow if nagios
5588 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5589 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5590 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005592 Example:
5593 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5594 acl add path /addacl
5595 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005597 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005599 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5600 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 Example:
5603 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5604 acl setmap path /setmap
5605 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005607 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005609 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5610 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5613 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005615http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005617 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5618 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5619 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5620 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5621 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5622 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5623 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5624 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5629 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5630 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5631 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5632 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5633 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5634 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5635 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005637http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005639 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5640 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005641
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005645 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5646 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5647 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5648 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5649 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005650
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005651 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5652 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5653 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5654 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5655 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5656 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5657 instead.
5658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005659 Example:
5660 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5661 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005662
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005663http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005664
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005665 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005667http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5668 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5671 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5672 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5673 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5674 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5675 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5676 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5677 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5678 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005680 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5681 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5682 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005683 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5684
5685 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5686 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5687 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5688 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005690http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5693 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5694 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5695 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5696 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5697 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005698
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005699http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005700
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005701 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5702 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5703 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5704 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5705 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005707http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005709 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5710 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5711 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5712 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5713 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5714 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005715
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005716http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5717http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5718 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5719 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5720 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005722
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005723 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5724 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5725 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005726 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005727 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5728 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5729 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005730 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005731 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005732
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005733http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5734 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5735 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5736 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5737
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005738http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5739
5740 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5741 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5742 pointed by <resolvers>.
5743 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5744 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5745 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5746 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5747 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5748 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5749 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5750 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5751 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5752 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5753 to 0.0.0.0.
5754
5755 Example:
5756 resolvers mydns
5757 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5758 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5759 timeout retry 1s
5760 hold valid 10s
5761 hold nx 3s
5762 hold other 3s
5763 hold obsolete 0s
5764 accepted_payload_size 8192
5765
5766 frontend fe
5767 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5768 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5769 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5770
5771 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5772 # which mean DNS resolution error
5773 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5774
5775 default_backend be
5776
5777 backend b_503
5778 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5779 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5780 # 503 error page to end users
5781
5782 backend be
5783 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5784 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5785 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5786 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5787 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5788
5789 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5790 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5791
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005792http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5793
5794 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5795 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5796 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5797 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005798 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5799 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005800
5801 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005805 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5806 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5807 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5808 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5809 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5814 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5815 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5816 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005818http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005820
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005821 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005822 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5823 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5824 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5825 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5826 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005827
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005828 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5829 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5830 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5831 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5832 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005833
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005834 Example:
5835 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5836
5837 # applied to:
5838 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5839
5840 # outputs:
5841 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5842
5843 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005844
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005845 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5846
5847 # applied to:
5848 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005849
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005850 # outputs:
5851 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005852
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005853http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5854 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5855
5856 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5857 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005858 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5859 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5860 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005861
5862 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5863 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5864 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5865
5866 Example:
5867 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5868 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5869
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005870 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5871 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5872 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5873 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5874
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005875http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5876 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5877
5878 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5879 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5880 query-string are replaced.
5881
5882 Example:
5883 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5884 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5885
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005886http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5887 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005889 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5890 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5891 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5892 against.
5893
5894 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5895 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5896 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005897
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005898 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5899 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5900 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5901 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5902 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5903 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5904 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5905 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5906 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005907 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5908 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005909
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005910 Example:
5911 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5912 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005913
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005914 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5915 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005916
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005917http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5918 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005919
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005920 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5921 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5922 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5923 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005924
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005925 Example:
5926 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005927
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005928 # applied to:
5929 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005930
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005931 # outputs:
5932 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005933
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005934http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5935 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5936 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005937 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005938 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5939
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005940 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005941 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5942 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005943 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005944 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005945 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005946 are followed to create the response :
5947
5948 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5949 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5950 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5951 ignored.
5952
5953 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5954 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005955 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005956 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5957 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005958
5959 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5960 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5961 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005962 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005963 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005964
5965 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5966 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5967 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005968 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005969 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5970 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005971
5972 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5973 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5974 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5975 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5976 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5977 as a raw content.
5978
5979 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5980 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5981 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5982 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5983 considered as a raw string.
5984
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005985 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005986 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5987 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5988 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5989
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005990 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5991 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005992 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005993
5994 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5995
5996 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005997 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005998 if { path /ping }
5999
6000 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6001 if { path /favicon.ico }
6002
6003 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6004 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6005 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006007http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6008http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006010 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6011 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6012 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006013
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006014http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6015 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006016
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006017 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6018 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6019 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6020 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6025 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6026 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6027 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6028 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 Arguments:
6031 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6032 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 Example:
6035 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6036 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6039 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6044 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6045 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006047 Arguments:
6048 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6049 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 Example:
6052 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6053 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6056 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6057 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6062 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6063 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6064 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6065 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 Example:
6068 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6069 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6070 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6071 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6072 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6073 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6074 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6075 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6076 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6081 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6082 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6083 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6084 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6087 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6090 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6091 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6092 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6093 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6094 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6095 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6096 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6097 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6102 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6103 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6104 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6105 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6106 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6107 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6112 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6113 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006117 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6118 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6119 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6120 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6121 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6122 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6123 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6124 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006128 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6129 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6130 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6131 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6132 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6133 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006135 Example :
6136 # prepend the host name before the path
6137 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006138
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006139http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6140
6141 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6142 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6143 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006145http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6148 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6149 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6150 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6151 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006153http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6156 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6157 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6158 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6159 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6160 values have higher priority.
6161 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6162 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6163 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6164 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6165 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006167http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6170 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6171 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6172 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6173 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6174 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6175 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006177 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006178
6179 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6181 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006183http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6184 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6185 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6186 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006187 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6188 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189
6190 Arguments :
6191 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6192 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006193
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006194 See also "option forwardfor".
6195
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006196 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006197 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6198 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6199
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006200 # After the masking this will track connections
6201 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6202 http-request track-sc0 src
6203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006204 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6205 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6206
6207http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6208
6209 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6210 expression.
6211
6212 Arguments:
6213 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6214 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006215
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006216 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006217 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6218 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6219
6220 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6221 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6222 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6223
6224http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6225
6226 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6227 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6228 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6229 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6230 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6231 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6232 information from the request.
6233
6234 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6235
6236http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6237
6238 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6239 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6240 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6241 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6242 path and the query string.
6243 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6244
6245http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6246
6247 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6248 inline.
6249
6250 Arguments:
6251 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6252 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6253 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6254 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6255 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6256 (request and response)
6257 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6258 processing
6259 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6260 processing
6261 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6262 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6263 and '_'.
6264
6265 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6266 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006267
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006268 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006269 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006271http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006274 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6275 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6276 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6277 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6278 agent name must be used.
6279
6280 Arguments:
6281 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6282
6283 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6284 configuration.
6285
6286http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6287
6288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6289 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6290 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6291 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6292 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6293 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6294 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6295 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6296 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6297 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6298 action.
6299 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6300 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6301 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6302 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6303 you fully understand how it works.
6304
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006305http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6306
6307 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6308 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6309 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6310 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6311 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006312 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006313 processing.
6314
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006315 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006316 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6317 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6318 rules evaluation.
6319
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006320http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6321http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6322 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6323 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6324 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6325 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006326
6327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6328 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6329 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006330 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6331 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6332 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6333 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6334 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6335 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6336 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6337 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6338 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6339 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006340 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006341 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6342 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6343 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6344 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6345 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346
6347http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6350
6351 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6352 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6353 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6354 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006355 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6357 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6358 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6359 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6360 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6361 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6362 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6363
6364 Arguments :
6365 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6366 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6367 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6368 select which table entry to update the counters.
6369
6370 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6371 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6372 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6373 that table until the session ends.
6374
6375 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6376 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6377 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6378 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6379 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6380 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6381 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6382 useful information.
6383
6384 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6385 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6386 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6387 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6388 checks that make use of it.
6389
6390http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6391
6392 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006393
6394 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006395 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006396
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006397http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6398
6399 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6400 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6401 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6402 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6403 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6404 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6405
6406 Arguments :
6407 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6408
6409 Example:
6410 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006412http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006414 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6415 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6416 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006417
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006418
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006419http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006420 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6421
6422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 no | yes | yes | yes
6424
6425 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6426 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6427 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6428 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6429 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6430 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006432 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6433 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006435 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006436
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006437 Example:
6438 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006439
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006440 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006442 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6443 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006444
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006445 Example:
6446 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006448 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006450 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6451 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6454 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006456http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006458 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6459 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6460 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6461 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6462 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6463 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6464 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6465 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006467http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006469 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6470 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6471 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6472 example, or to pass some internal information.
6473 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6474 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6475 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006477http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006479 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6480 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006481
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006482http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006483
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006484 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006485
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006486http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006487
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006488 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6489 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6490 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6491 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6492 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6493 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6494 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006495
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006496 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6497 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6498 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6499 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6500 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006501
6502 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6503 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6504 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6505 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006507http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006508
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006509 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6510 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6511 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6512 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6513 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6514 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006515
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006516http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006517
Maciej Zdeb36662462020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006518 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6519 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6520 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6521 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6522 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006523
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006524http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006525
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006526 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6527 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6528 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6529 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6530 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6531 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006532
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006533http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6534http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6535 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6536 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6537 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6538 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006539
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006540 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6541 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6542 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006543 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006544 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6545 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6546 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006547 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006548 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006550http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006551
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006552 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6553 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6554 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6555 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6556 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6557 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006558
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006559http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6560 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006561
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006562 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6563 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006564
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006565 Example:
6566 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006567
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006568 # applied to:
6569 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006570
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006571 # outputs:
6572 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006573
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006574 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006576http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6577 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006579 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006580 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006582 Example:
6583 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006585 # applied to:
6586 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006588 # outputs:
6589 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006590
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006591http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6592 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6593 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006594 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006595 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6596
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006597 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006598 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6599 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006600 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006601 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006602 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006603 are followed to create the response :
6604
6605 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6606 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6607 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6608 ignored.
6609
6610 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6611 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006612 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006613 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6614 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006615
6616 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6617 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6618 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006619 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006620 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006621
6622 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6623 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6624 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006625 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006626 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6627 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006628
6629 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6630 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6631 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6632 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6633 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6634 as a raw content.
6635
6636 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6637 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6638 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6639 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6640 considered as a raw string.
6641
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006642 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6643 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6644 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6645 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6646
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006647 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6648 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006649 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006650
6651 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6652
6653 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006654 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006655 if { status eq 404 }
6656
6657 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6658 string "This is the end !" \
6659 if { status eq 500 }
6660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006661http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6662http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006664 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6665 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6666 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006667
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006668http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006670
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006671 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6672 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6673 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6674 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006676http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006678 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6679 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6680 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6681 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6682 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006683
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006684 Arguments:
6685 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006687 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6688 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006690http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006692 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6693 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6694 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006695
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006696http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6697
6698 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6699 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6700 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6701 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6702 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6703
6704http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6705
6706 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6707 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6708 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6709 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6710 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6711 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6712 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6713 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6714 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6715
6716http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6717
6718 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6719 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6720 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6721 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6722 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6723 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6724 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6725
6726http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6727
6728 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6729 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6730 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6731 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6732 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6733 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6734 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6735 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6736
6737http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6738 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6739
6740 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6741 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6742 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6743 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006744
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006745 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006746 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6747 http-response set-status 431
6748 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6749 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006751http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006753 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6754 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6755 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6756 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6757 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6758 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6759 based on some information from the request.
6760
6761 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6762
6763http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6764
6765 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6766 inline.
6767
6768 Arguments:
6769 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6770 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6771 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6772 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6773 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6774 (request and response)
6775 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6776 processing
6777 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6778 processing
6779 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6780 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6781 and '_'.
6782
6783 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6784 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006785
6786 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006787 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006789http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006791 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6792 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6793 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6794 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6795 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6796 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6797 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6798 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6799 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6800 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6801 action.
6802 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6803 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6804 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6805 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6806 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006807
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006808http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6809
6810 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6811 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6812 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6813 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6814 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006815 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006816 processing.
6817
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006818 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006820 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006821 rules evaluation.
6822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006823http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006827 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6828 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6829 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6830 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6831 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6832 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6833
6834http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835
6836 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6837 about <var-name>.
6838
6839 Example:
6840 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6841
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006842
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006843http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6844 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6845
6846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 yes | no | yes | yes
6848
6849 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006850 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6851 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6852 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006853
6854 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6855
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006856 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6857 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6858 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6859 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6860 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6861 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6862 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6863 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6864 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6865 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006866
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006867 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6868 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6869 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6870 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6871 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6872 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6873 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006874 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6875 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6876 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6877 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6878 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6879 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006880
6881 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6882 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6883 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6884 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6885 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6886 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6887 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6888 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006889 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006890 downsides of rare connection failures.
6891
6892 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6893 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6894 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6895 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6896 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6897 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006898 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006899 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6900 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6901 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6902 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6903 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6904
6905 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006906 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6907 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6908 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006909
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006910 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6911 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6912 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006913
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006914 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6915 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006916
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006917 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006918
6919 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6920 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6921 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6922
6923 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6924
6925
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006926http-send-name-header [<header>]
6927 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6929 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006930 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006931 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6932
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006933 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6934 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6935 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6936 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6937 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6938 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6939 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6940 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6941 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6942 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6943 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6944 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6945 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6946 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6947 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6948 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006949
6950 See also : "server"
6951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006952id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006953 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6955 no | yes | yes | yes
6956 Arguments : none
6957
6958 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6959 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6960 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006961
6962
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006963ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6964 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006966 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006967
6968 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6969 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6970 and running).
6971
6972 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6973 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6974 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006975 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006976 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6977
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006978 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6979 "unless" condition is met.
6980
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006981 Example:
6982 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6983 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6984 ignore-persist if url_static
6985
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006986 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6987
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006988load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6989 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6991 yes | no | yes | yes
6992
6993 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6994 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6995 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006996 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006997 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6998 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6999 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7000 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007002 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007003 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007004 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007005
7006 Arguments:
7007 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7008 named "server-state-file".
7009
7010 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7011 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7012 name is used as a file name.
7013
7014 none don't load any stat for this backend
7015
7016 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007017 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7018 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7019 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007020 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007021 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007022
7023 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7024 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7025
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007026 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007027
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007028 global
7029 stats socket /tmp/socket
7030 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007031
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007032 defaults
7033 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007034
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007035 backend bk
7036 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7037 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007038
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007039
7040 Then one can run :
7041
7042 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7043
7044 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7045
7046 1
7047 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7048 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7049 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7050
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007051 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007052
7053 global
7054 stats socket /tmp/socket
7055 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7056
7057 defaults
7058 load-server-state-from-file local
7059
7060 backend bk
7061 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7062 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7063
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007064
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007065 Then one can run :
7066
7067 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7068
7069 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7070
7071 1
7072 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7073 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7074 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7075
7076 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7077 "show servers state"
7078
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007079
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007080log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007081log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7082 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007083no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007084 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7086 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007087
7088 Prefix :
7089 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7090 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7091 prefix does not allow arguments.
7092
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007093 Arguments :
7094 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7095 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7096 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7097 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7098 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7099 parameter.
7100
7101 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7102 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7103
7104 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7105 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7106 standard syslog port).
7107
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007108 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7109 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7110 standard syslog port).
7111
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007112 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7113 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7114 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007115 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007116
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007117 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7118 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7119 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7120 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7121 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7122 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7123 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7124 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7125 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7126 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7127 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7128 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7129 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7130 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7131 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7132 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007133 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7134 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007135
7136 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7137 and "fd@2", see above.
7138
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007139 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7140 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7141 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7142 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7143 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7144 having the logs instantly available.
7145
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007146 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7147 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007148
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007149 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7150 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7151 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7152 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7153 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7154 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7155 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7156 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7157 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7158 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007159 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007160
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007161 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7162 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7163 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7164 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7165 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7166
7167 <sample_size>
7168 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7169 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7170 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7171 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7172 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7173
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007174 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7175 one of the following :
7176
7177 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
7178 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7179
7180 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7181 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7182
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007183 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7184 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7185 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7186 designed to be used with a local log server.
7187
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007188 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7189 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7190 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7191 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7192 systemd logger consumes.
7193
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007194 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7195 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7196 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7197 used with a local log server.
7198
7199 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7200 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7201 designed to be used with a local log server.
7202
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007203 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7204 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7205 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7206 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7207
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007208 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7209
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007210 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7211 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7212 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7213
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007214 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7215 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7216 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7217 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007218
7219 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7220 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7221 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007222 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7223 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7224 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7225 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7226 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007227
7228 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7229
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007230 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7231 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7232 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007233
7234 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7235 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7236 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7237 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7238
7239 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7240 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007241
7242 Example :
7243 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007244 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7245 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7246 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007247 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7248 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007249 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007250
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007251
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007252log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007253 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7254 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7255 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007256
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007257 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7258 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7259 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7260 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7261 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007262
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007263 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7264 "option httplog" directives.
7265
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007266log-format-sd <string>
7267 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7268 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 yes | yes | yes | no
7270
7271 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7272 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7273 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7274 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7275 which covers the log format string in depth.
7276
7277 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7278 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7279
7280 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7281 log format to "rfc5424".
7282
7283 Example :
7284 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7285
7286
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007287log-tag <string>
7288 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7290 yes | yes | yes | yes
7291
7292 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7293 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7294 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7295 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7296 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7297 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7298 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7299 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7300 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007301
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007302max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7303 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | no | yes | yes
7306
7307 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7308 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7309 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7310 servers.
7311
7312 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7313 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7314 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7315 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7316 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007317 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007318 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7319 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7320 picking a different server.
7321
7322 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7323 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7324 even if they have to be queued.
7325
7326 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7327 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7328
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007329max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7330 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7331 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7332 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007333
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007334maxconn <conns>
7335 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | yes | yes | no
7338 Arguments :
7339 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7340 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7341 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7342 closes.
7343
7344 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7345 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7346 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7347 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007348 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7349 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7350 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7351 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007352
7353 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7354 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7355 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7356
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007357 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7358 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007360 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7361
7362
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007363mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007364 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 yes | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments :
7368 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7369 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7370 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7371 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7372
7373 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7374 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7375 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7376 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7377 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7378
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007379 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7380 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7381 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007382
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007383 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007384 defaults http_instances
7385 mode http
7386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007387
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007388monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007389 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7391 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007392 Arguments :
7393 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7394 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007395 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007396 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7397 backend and its backup.
7398
7399 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7400 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7401 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7402 servers in a list of backends.
7403
7404 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7405 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7406 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7407 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7408 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7409 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7410 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007411 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7412 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007413
7414 Example:
7415 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007416 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007417 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7418 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7419 monitor-uri /site_alive
7420 monitor fail if site_dead
7421
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007422 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007423
7424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007425monitor-uri <uri>
7426 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7428 yes | yes | yes | no
7429 Arguments :
7430 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7431 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7432
7433 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7434 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7435 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7436 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7437 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7438 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7439 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7440 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7441
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007442 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007443 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7444 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7445 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7446 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7447 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7448 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007449
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007450 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7451 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7452 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7453 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7454
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007455 Example :
7456 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7457 frontend www
7458 mode http
7459 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7460
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007461 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007463
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007464option abortonclose
7465no option abortonclose
7466 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7468 yes | no | yes | yes
7469 Arguments : none
7470
7471 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7472 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7473 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7474 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007475 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007476 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7477 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7478 encountered while delivering the response.
7479
7480 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7481 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7482 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7483 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7484 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7485 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007486 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007487 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007488 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007489 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7490 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7491 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7492
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007493 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7494 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007495 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7496 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7497 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7498 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7499 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7500 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007501 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007502
7503 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7504 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7505
7506 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7507
7508
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007509option accept-invalid-http-request
7510no option accept-invalid-http-request
7511 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7513 yes | yes | yes | no
7514 Arguments : none
7515
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007516 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007517 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007518 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007519 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7520 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7521 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7522 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7523 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007524 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7525 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7526 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7527 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007529 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007530 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7531 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7532 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007533
7534 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7535 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7536 been confirmed.
7537
7538 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7539 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007540 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7541 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007542 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7543
7544 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7545 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7546
7547 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7548 stats socket.
7549
7550
7551option accept-invalid-http-response
7552no option accept-invalid-http-response
7553 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7555 yes | no | yes | yes
7556 Arguments : none
7557
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007558 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007559 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007560 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007561 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7562 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7563 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7564 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7565 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007566 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7567 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7568 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007569
7570 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7571 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7572 been confirmed.
7573
7574 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7575 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7576 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7577 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7578
7579 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7580 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7581
7582 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7583 stats socket.
7584
7585
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007586option allbackups
7587no option allbackups
7588 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7590 yes | no | yes | yes
7591 Arguments : none
7592
7593 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7594 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7595 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7596 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7597 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7598 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7599 order between the backup servers anymore.
7600
7601 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7602 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7603
7604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7606
7607
7608option checkcache
7609no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007610 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 yes | no | yes | yes
7613 Arguments : none
7614
7615 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7616 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007617 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007618 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7619 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007620 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007621
7622 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007623 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007624 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007625 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7626 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007627 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007628 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007629 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7630 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007631 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007632 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7633 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007634 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007635 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7636 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7637 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7638 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7639 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7640 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7641 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7642 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7643 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7644
7645 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007646 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7647 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7648 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7649 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650
7651 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7652 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007653 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007654 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007655
7656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7658
7659
7660option clitcpka
7661no option clitcpka
7662 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | yes | yes | no
7665 Arguments : none
7666
7667 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7668 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007669 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007670 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7671
7672 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7673 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7674 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7675 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7676
7677 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7678 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7679 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7680 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7681 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7682
7683 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7684
7685 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7686 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7687 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7688
7689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7691
7692 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7693
7694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007695option contstats
7696 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7698 yes | yes | yes | no
7699 Arguments : none
7700
7701 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7702 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7703 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7704 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007705 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7706 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7707 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7708 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7709 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007710
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007711option disable-h2-upgrade
7712no option disable-h2-upgrade
7713 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7714 connection.
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | yes | yes | no
7717 Arguments : none
7718
7719 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7720 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7721 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7722 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7723 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7724 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7725 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7726 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7727
7728 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7729 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007730
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007731option dontlog-normal
7732no option dontlog-normal
7733 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7735 yes | yes | yes | no
7736 Arguments : none
7737
7738 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7739 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7740 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7741 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7742 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7743 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7744 logged.
7745
7746 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7747 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7748 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007750 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007751 logging.
7752
7753
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007754option dontlognull
7755no option dontlognull
7756 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7758 yes | yes | yes | no
7759 Arguments : none
7760
7761 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7762 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7763 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7764 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7765 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7766 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007767 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7768 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7769 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007770
7771 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007772 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007773 would not be logged.
7774
7775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7777
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007778 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007779 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007780
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007781
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007782option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007783 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | yes | yes | yes
7786 Arguments :
7787 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7788 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007789 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007790 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007791
7792 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7793 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7794 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7795 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7796 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7797 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7798 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007799 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7800 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7801 possible that the client has already brought one.
7802
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007803 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007804 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007805 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007806 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007807 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007808 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007809
7810 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7811 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7812 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7813 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7814 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7815 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7816 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7817
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007818 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7819 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7820 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7821 are under the control of the end-user.
7822
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007823 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007824 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7825 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007826 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7827 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7828 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007829
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007830 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007831 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7832 frontend www
7833 mode http
7834 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7835
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007836 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7837 backend www
7838 mode http
7839 option forwardfor header X-Client
7840
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007841 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007842 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007843
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007844
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007845option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7846no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7847 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | yes | yes | no
7850 Arguments : none
7851
7852 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7853 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7854 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7855 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7856 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7857 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7858 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7859
7860 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7861 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7862 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7863 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7864 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7865 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7866 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7867 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7868 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7869 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7870
7871 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7872
7873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7875
7876 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7877 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7878
7879
7880option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7881no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7882 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7884 yes | no | yes | yes
7885 Arguments : none
7886
7887 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7888 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7889 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7890 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7891 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7892 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7893 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7894
7895 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7896 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7897 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7898 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7899 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7900 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7901 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7902 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7903 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7904 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7905
7906 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7907
7908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7910
7911 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7912 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7913
7914
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007915option http-buffer-request
7916no option http-buffer-request
7917 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7919 yes | yes | yes | yes
7920 Arguments : none
7921
7922 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7923 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7924 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7925 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7926 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7927 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007928 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7929 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7930 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7931 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007932
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007933 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007934
7935
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007936option http-ignore-probes
7937no option http-ignore-probes
7938 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | yes | yes | no
7941 Arguments : none
7942
7943 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7944 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7945 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7946 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7947 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7948 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7949 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7950 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7951 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007952 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7953 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007954 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7955
7956 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7957 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7958 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7959 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7960 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7961 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7962 are often the only way to detect them.
7963
7964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7966
7967 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7968
7969
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007970option http-keep-alive
7971no option http-keep-alive
7972 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7974 yes | yes | yes | yes
7975 Arguments : none
7976
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007977 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7978 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007979 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7980 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007981 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7982 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7983 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007984
7985 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7986 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007987 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7988 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7989 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7990 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7991 situations where this option may be useful :
7992
7993 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007994 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007995
7996 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7997 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7998
7999 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8000 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8001 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8002 request.
8003
8004 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8005 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008006 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8007 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8008 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008009
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008010 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8011 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8012 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8013 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8014 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8015 not set.
8016
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008017 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8018 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8019 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008020
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008021 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008022 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008023 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008024
8025
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008026option http-no-delay
8027no option http-no-delay
8028 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 yes | yes | yes | yes
8031 Arguments : none
8032
8033 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8034 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8035 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8036 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8037 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8038 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8039 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8040 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8041 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8042 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8043 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8044 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8045 affected.
8046
8047 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8048 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8049 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8050 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8051 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8052 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8053 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8054 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8055 latency environments.
8056
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008057 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8058
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008059
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008060option http-pretend-keepalive
8061no option http-pretend-keepalive
8062 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008064 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008065 Arguments : none
8066
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008067 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008068 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8069 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8070 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8071 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8072 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8073 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8074 consider the response complete.
8075
8076 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8077 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8078 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8079 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008080 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008081 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8082
8083 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8084 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8085 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8086 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8087 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8088 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8089 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8090
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008091 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8092 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8093 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8094 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8095 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8096 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008097
8098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8100
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008101 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008102 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008103
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008104
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008105option http-server-close
8106no option http-server-close
8107 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | yes | yes | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008112 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8113 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8114 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8115 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008116 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8117 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8118 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8119 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8120 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8121 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8122 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8123 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8124 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8125 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8126 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008127
8128 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8129 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8130 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8131 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008132 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8133 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008134
8135 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8136 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008137 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8138 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8139 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008140
8141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008144 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8145 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008146
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008147option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008148no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008149 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8151 yes | yes | yes | no
8152 Arguments : none
8153
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008154 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008155 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8156 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8157 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8158 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8159 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8160 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8161
8162 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8163 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008164 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8165 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8166 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008167
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008168 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8169 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8170 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8171 front of an existing proxy.
8172
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008173 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8174
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008175 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008176
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008177option httpchk
8178option httpchk <uri>
8179option httpchk <method> <uri>
8180option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008181 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 yes | no | yes | yes
8184 Arguments :
8185 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8186 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8187 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8188 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8189 ones.
8190
8191 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8192 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8193 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8194
8195 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8196 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8197 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008198 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008199
8200 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8201 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8202 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8203 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8204 the lack of any response.
8205
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008206 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8207 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8208 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8209 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8210
8211 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8212 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8213 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008214
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008215 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8216 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008217 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008218 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008219 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008220
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008221 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8222 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8223 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8224 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8225
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008226 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008227 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8228 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8229 backend https_relay
8230 mode tcp
8231 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8232 http-check send hdr Host www
8233 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008234
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008235 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8236 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8237 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008238
8239
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008240option httpclose
8241no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008242 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 yes | yes | yes | yes
8245 Arguments : none
8246
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008247 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8248 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8249 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8250 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008251 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008252
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008253 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8254 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008255 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008256 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8257 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008258
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008259 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8260 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8261 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008262
8263 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8264 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008265 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8266 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8267 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008268
8269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8271
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008272 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008273
8274
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008275option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008276 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008278 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008279 Arguments :
8280 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8281 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8282 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008283 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008284 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008285
8286 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8287 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8288 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8289 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8290 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8291 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8292 ports.
8293
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008294 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8295 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008296
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008297 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008299 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008300
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008301
8302option http_proxy
8303no option http_proxy
8304 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | yes | yes | yes
8307 Arguments : none
8308
8309 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8310 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8311 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8312 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8313 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8314
8315 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8316 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008317 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8318 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008319
8320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8322
8323 Example :
8324 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8325 backend direct_forward
8326 option httpclose
8327 option http_proxy
8328
8329 See also : "option httpclose"
8330
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008331
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008332option independent-streams
8333no option independent-streams
8334 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 yes | yes | yes | yes
8337 Arguments : none
8338
8339 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8340 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8341 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8342 receive data or not.
8343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008344 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008345 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8346 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8347 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8348 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8349 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8350 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8351 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8352 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8353 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8354 socket buffers.
8355
8356 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8357 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8358 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8359 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8360 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8361
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008362 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008363
8364
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008365option ldap-check
8366 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 yes | no | yes | yes
8369 Arguments : none
8370
8371 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8372 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8373 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8374 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8375
8376 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8377 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8378
8379 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8380 configure it.
8381
8382 Example :
8383 option ldap-check
8384
8385 See also : "option httpchk"
8386
8387
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008388option external-check
8389 Use external processes for server health checks
8390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8391 yes | no | yes | yes
8392
8393 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8394 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8395 command".
8396
8397 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8398
8399 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8400
8401
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008402option log-health-checks
8403no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008404 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8406 yes | no | yes | yes
8407 Arguments : none
8408
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008409 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8410 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8411 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008412
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008413 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8414 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8415 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8416 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8417 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8418
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008419 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008420 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008421
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008422 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8423 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8424 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008425
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008426
8427option log-separate-errors
8428no option log-separate-errors
8429 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8431 yes | yes | yes | no
8432 Arguments : none
8433
8434 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8435 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8436 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8437 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8438 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8439 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8440 provides very important information.
8441
8442 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8443 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8444 error logs.
8445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008446 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008447 logging.
8448
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008449
8450option logasap
8451no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008452 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8454 yes | yes | yes | no
8455 Arguments : none
8456
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008457 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8458 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8459 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8460 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8461
8462 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8463 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8464 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8465 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8466 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008467 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008468 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8469 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8470 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8471 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008472 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008474 Examples :
8475 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8476 mode http
8477 option httplog
8478 option logasap
8479 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8480
8481 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8482 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8483 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8484 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008486 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008487 logging.
8488
8489
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008490option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008491 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8493 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008494 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008495 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8496 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008497 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8498 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008499
8500 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8501 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008502 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008503 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8504 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8505 in the MySQL table, like this :
8506
8507 USE mysql;
8508 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8509 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8510
8511 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008512 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008513 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8514 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8515 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8516 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8517 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8518 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8519 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8520
8521 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8522 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008523
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008524 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008525
8526 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8527 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8528 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8529 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008530 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8531 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008532
8533 See also: "option httpchk"
8534
8535
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008536option nolinger
8537no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008538 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8540 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008541 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008543 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008544 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8545 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8546 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8547 connections.
8548
8549 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8550 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008551 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8552 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8553 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8554 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8555 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8556 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8557 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8558 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8559 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8560 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8561 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8562 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8563 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008564
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008565 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8566 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8567 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8568 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8569 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008570
8571 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8572 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008573 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8574 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8575 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008576
8577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8579
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008580 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8581 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008582
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008583option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8584 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8586 yes | yes | yes | yes
8587 Arguments :
8588 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8589 matching <network>
8590 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8591 header name.
8592
8593 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8594 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8595 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8596 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8597 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8598 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8599 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8600 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8601 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8602 possible that the client has already brought one.
8603
8604 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8605 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8606 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8607 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8608 header and requires different one.
8609
8610 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8611 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8612 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8613 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8614 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8615 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8616 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8617
8618 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8619 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8620 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8621 both are defined.
8622
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008623 Examples :
8624 # Original Destination address
8625 frontend www
8626 mode http
8627 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8628
8629 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8630 backend www
8631 mode http
8632 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8633
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008634 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008635
8636
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008637option persist
8638no option persist
8639 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8641 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008642 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008643
8644 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8645 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8646 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8647 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8648 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8649 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8650 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8651 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8652 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8653 redirected to another valid server.
8654
8655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8657
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008658 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008659
8660
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008661option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8662 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8664 yes | no | yes | yes
8665 Arguments :
8666 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8667 PostgreSQL server.
8668
8669 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8670 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8671 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8672 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8673
8674 See also: "option httpchk"
8675
8676
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008677option prefer-last-server
8678no option prefer-last-server
8679 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8681 yes | no | yes | yes
8682 Arguments : none
8683
8684 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8685 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8686 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8687 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8688 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8689 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8690 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8691 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8692 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008693 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8694 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008695 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8696 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8697 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008698 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8699 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8700 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008701
8702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8704
8705 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8706
8707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008708option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008709option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008710no option redispatch
8711 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8713 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008714 Arguments :
8715 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8716 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8717 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008718 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008719 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008720 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008721 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8722 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8723 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008725
8726 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8727 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8728 be able to access the service anymore.
8729
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008730 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8731 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008732
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008733 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8734 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8735 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8736 following order:
8737
8738 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8739
8740 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8741 list, or
8742
8743 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8744
8745 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8746 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8747
8748 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8749 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8750 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8751 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8752
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008753 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008754 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8755 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8759
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008760 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008761
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008762
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008763option redis-check
8764 Use redis health checks for server testing
8765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8766 yes | no | yes | yes
8767 Arguments : none
8768
8769 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8770 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8771 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8772 find the "+PONG" response message.
8773
8774 Example :
8775 option redis-check
8776
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008777 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008778
8779
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008780option smtpchk
8781option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8782 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8784 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008785 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008786 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008787 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008788 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8789
8790 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8791 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8792 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8793
8794 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8795 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8796 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8797 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8798 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8799 dead server.
8800
8801 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8802 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008803 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008804 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8805
8806 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8807 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8808 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8809 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008810 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008811
8812 Example :
8813 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8814
8815 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008818option socket-stats
8819no option socket-stats
8820
8821 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | yes | yes | no
8824
8825 Arguments : none
8826
8827
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008828option splice-auto
8829no option splice-auto
8830 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | yes
8833 Arguments : none
8834
8835 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8836 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008837 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008838 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008839 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008840 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8841 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8842 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8843 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8844
8845 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8846 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8847 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8848 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8849 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8850 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8851 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8852 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8853 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8854 keyword.
8855
8856 Example :
8857 option splice-auto
8858
8859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8861
8862 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8863 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8864
8865
8866option splice-request
8867no option splice-request
8868 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8870 yes | yes | yes | yes
8871 Arguments : none
8872
8873 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008874 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008875 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8876 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8877 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8878 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8879
8880 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8881
8882 Example :
8883 option splice-request
8884
8885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8887
8888 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8889 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8890
8891
8892option splice-response
8893no option splice-response
8894 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8896 yes | yes | yes | yes
8897 Arguments : none
8898
8899 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008900 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008901 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8902 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8903 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8904 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8905
8906 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8907
8908 Example :
8909 option splice-response
8910
8911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8913
8914 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8915 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8916
8917
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008918option spop-check
8919 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8921 no | no | no | yes
8922 Arguments : none
8923
8924 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8925 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8926 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8927 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8928
8929 Example :
8930 option spop-check
8931
8932 See also : "option httpchk"
8933
8934
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008935option srvtcpka
8936no option srvtcpka
8937 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8939 yes | no | yes | yes
8940 Arguments : none
8941
8942 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8943 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008944 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008945 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8946
8947 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8948 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8949 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8950 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8951
8952 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8953 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8954 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8955 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8956 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8957
8958 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8959
8960 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8961 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8962 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8963
8964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8966
8967 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8968
8969
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008970option ssl-hello-chk
8971 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 yes | no | yes | yes
8974 Arguments : none
8975
8976 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8977 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8978 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8979 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8980 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8981 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8982 hello message.
8983
8984 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8985 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8986 messages, which is appreciable.
8987
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008988 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8989 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8990 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008991
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008992 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8993
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008994
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008995option tcp-check
8996 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8998 yes | no | yes | yes
8999
9000 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9001 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9002
9003 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9004 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9005 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9006
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009007 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009008 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9009 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9010 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9011 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9012 only.
9013
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009014 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009015 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9016 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9017 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9018 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9019
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009020 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009021 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9022 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009023 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009024 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9025 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9026 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9027 the respective protocols.
9028 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009029 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009030
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009031 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009032
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009033 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9034 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9035 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9036 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009037
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009038 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9039 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9040 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009041
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009042
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009043 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009044 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009045 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009046 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009048 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009049 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009050 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009051
9052 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9053 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009054 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009055 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009056 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009057 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009058 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009059 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009060 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9061 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009062 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9064 tcp-check expect string +OK
9065
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009067 (send many headers before analyzing)
9068 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009069 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009070 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9071 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9072 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9073 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009074 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009075
9076
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009077 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009078
9079
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009080option tcp-smart-accept
9081no option tcp-smart-accept
9082 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9084 yes | yes | yes | no
9085 Arguments : none
9086
9087 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9088 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9089 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9090 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9091 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9092 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9093
9094 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9095 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9096 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9097 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9098
9099 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9100 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9101 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009102 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009103
9104 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9105 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9106 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9107
9108 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9109 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9110 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9111
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009112 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9113
9114
9115option tcp-smart-connect
9116no option tcp-smart-connect
9117 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9119 yes | no | yes | yes
9120 Arguments : none
9121
9122 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9123 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9124 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9125 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9126 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9127
9128 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9129 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9130 complex.
9131
9132 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9133 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9134 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9135
9136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9138
9139 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9140
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009141
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009142option tcpka
9143 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9145 yes | yes | yes | yes
9146 Arguments : none
9147
9148 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9149 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009151 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9152
9153 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9154 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9155 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9156 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9157
9158 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9159 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9160 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9161 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9162 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9163
9164 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9165
9166 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9167 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9168 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9169 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9170 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9171 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9172 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9173 backends.
9174
9175 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9176
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009177
9178option tcplog
9179 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009181 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009182 Arguments : none
9183
9184 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9185 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9186 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9187 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9188 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9189 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9190 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9191 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9192
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009193 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009195 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009196
9197
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009198option transparent
9199no option transparent
9200 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009202 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009203 Arguments : none
9204
9205 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9206 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9207 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9208 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9209 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9210 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9211 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9212 appropriate server.
9213
9214 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9215 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9216
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009217 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009218 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009219
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009220
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009221external-check command <command>
9222 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | no | yes | yes
9225
9226 Arguments :
9227 <command> is the external command to run
9228
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009229 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9230
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009231 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009232
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009233 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9234 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9235 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9236 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9237 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9238 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009239
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009240 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9241
9242 Environment variables :
9243 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9244 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9245
9246 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9247
9248 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9249
9250 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9251 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9252 for a UNIX socket).
9253
9254 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9255
9256 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9257
9258 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9259
9260 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9261
9262 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9263
9264 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9265 socket).
9266
9267 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9268 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9269
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009270 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9271
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009272 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9273 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9274 failed.
9275
9276 Example :
9277 external-check command /bin/true
9278
9279 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9280
9281
9282external-check path <path>
9283 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9285 yes | no | yes | yes
9286
9287 Arguments :
9288 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9289
9290 The default path is "".
9291
9292 Example :
9293 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9294
9295 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9296 "external-check command"
9297
9298
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009299persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009300persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009301 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9303 yes | no | yes | yes
9304 Arguments :
9305 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009306 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9307 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009308
9309 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9310 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009311 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009312 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9313 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9314 forwarded to this server.
9315
9316 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9317 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9318 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009319 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009320 a single "listen" section.
9321
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009322 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9323 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9324 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9325
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009326 Example :
9327 listen tse-farm
9328 bind :3389
9329 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9330 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9331 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9332 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9333 persist rdp-cookie
9334 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009335 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009336 balance rdp-cookie
9337 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9338 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9339
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009340 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9341 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009342
9343
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009344rate-limit sessions <rate>
9345 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9347 yes | yes | yes | no
9348 Arguments :
9349 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9350 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9351
9352 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9353 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9354 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9355 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9356 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9357 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9358
9359 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9360 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9361 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9362 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9363
9364 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9365 listen smtp
9366 mode tcp
9367 bind :25
9368 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009369 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009370
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009371 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9372 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9373 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009374
9375 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9376
9377
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009378redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9379redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9380redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009381 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 no | yes | yes | yes
9384
9385 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009386 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009387
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009388 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009389 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009390 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9391 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9392 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009393
9394 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9395 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9396 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9397 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9398 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009399 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9400 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9401 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9402 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009403
9404 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9405 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9406 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9407 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9408 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9409 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009410 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009411 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009412 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9413 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9414 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009415
9416 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009417 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9418 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9419 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009420 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009421 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9422 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9423 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9424 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009425
9426 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009427 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009428
9429 - "drop-query"
9430 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9431 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9432 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9433 with a location-type redirect.
9434
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009435 - "append-slash"
9436 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9437 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9438 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9439 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9440
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009441 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9442 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9443 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9444 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9445 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9446 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9447 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9448
9449 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9450 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9451 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9452 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9453 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9454 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9455 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009456
9457 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9458 acl clear dst_port 80
9459 acl secure dst_port 8080
9460 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009461 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009462 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009463 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9464
9465 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009466 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9467 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9468 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009469 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009470
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009471 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9472 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9473 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9474
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009475 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009476 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009477
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009478 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009479 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9480 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9481 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009483 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009484
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009485
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009486retries <value>
9487 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9489 yes | no | yes | yes
9490 Arguments :
9491 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9492 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9493 default value is 3.
9494
9495 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9496 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9497 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9498
9499 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009500 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9501 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009502
9503 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9504 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9505
9506 See also : "option redispatch"
9507
9508
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009509retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009510 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9511 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9512 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9514 yes | no | yes | yes
9515 Arguments :
9516 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9517 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9518 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9519 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9520
9521 none never retry
9522
9523 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9524 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9525
9526 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9527 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9528 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9529 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9530 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9531 processing the request.
9532
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009533 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9534 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9535 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9536 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9537 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9538 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9539 overflow attack for example).
9540
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009541 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9542 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9543 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9544 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9545 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9546 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9547 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9548 amplify denial of service attacks.
9549
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009550 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9551 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9552 considered to be safe to retry.
9553
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009554 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9555 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9556 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9557 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9558
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009559 all-retryable-errors
9560 retry request for any error that are considered
9561 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9562 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9563 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9564
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009565 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9566 not cumulative.
9567
9568 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9569 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9570 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9571 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9572
9573 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9574 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9575 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9576 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9577 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9578 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9579 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9580 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9581 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9582 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9583 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9584 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9585
9586 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9587 should not use this directive.
9588
9589 The default is "conn-failure".
9590
9591 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9592
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009593server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009594 Declare a server in a backend
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 no | no | yes | yes
9597 Arguments :
9598 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009599 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009600 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009601
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009602 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9603 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9604 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9605 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009606 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9607 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9608 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9609 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9610 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009611 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9612 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9613 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9614 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9615 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9616 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9617 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009618 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009619 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9620 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9621 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9622 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9623 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9624 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009625 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9626 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009627 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9628 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009629
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009630 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009631 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9632 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9633 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9634 adding this value to the client's port.
9635
9636 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9637 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009638 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009639
9640 Examples :
9641 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9642 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009643 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009644 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9645 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9646 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009647
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009648 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9649 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9650 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9651 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9652 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9653
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009654 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9655 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009656
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009657server-state-file-name [<file>]
9658 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9659 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9660 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9661 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9662 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9663 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9664
9665 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9666 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9667
9668 global
9669 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9670
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009671 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009672 load-server-state-from-file
9673
9674 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9675 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009676
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009677server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9678 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9679 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 no | no | yes | yes
9682
9683 Arguments:
9684 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9685
9686 <num | range>
9687 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9688 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9689 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9690 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9691
9692 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9693
9694 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9695
9696 <params*>
9697 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9698 keyword.
9699
9700 Examples:
9701 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9702 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9703 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9704
9705 # or
9706 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9707
9708 # would be equivalent to:
9709 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9710 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9711 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9712
9713
9714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009715source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009716source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009717source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009718 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9720 yes | no | yes | yes
9721 Arguments :
9722 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9723 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009725 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009726 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9727 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9728 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9729 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9730 supported prefixes are :
9731 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9732 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9733 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009734 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009735 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9736 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009737
9738 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9739 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009740 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9741 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9742 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009743
9744 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9745 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9746 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9747 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9748 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9749 <addr>.
9750
9751 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9752 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9753 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9754 port.
9755
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009756 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9757 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9758 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9759 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009760 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009761 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9762 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9763 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9764 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9765 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9766 HTTP header.
9767
9768 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9769 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009770 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009771 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9772 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9773 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9774 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9775 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9776 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9777 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9778
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009779 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9780 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9781 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9782 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9783 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9784 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9785
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009786 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9787 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9788 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9789 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9790
9791 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9792 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9793 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9794 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9795 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9796 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9797
9798 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9799 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9800 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9801 there are two methods :
9802
9803 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9804 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9805 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9806 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9807 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9808 of the client ranges may be used.
9809
9810 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9811 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9812 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9813 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9814 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9815 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9816 same session.
9817
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009818 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9819 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9820 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009821 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009822
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009823 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9824
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009825 Examples :
9826 backend private
9827 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9828 source 192.168.1.200
9829
9830 backend transparent_ssl1
9831 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9832 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9833
9834 backend transparent_ssl2
9835 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9836 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9837 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9838
9839 backend transparent_ssl3
9840 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9841 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9842 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9843
9844 backend transparent_smtp
9845 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9846 # with Tproxy version 4.
9847 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9848
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009849 backend transparent_http
9850 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9851 # proxy.
9852 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009854 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009855 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009857
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009858srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9859 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9860 the connection on the server side.
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 yes | no | yes | yes
9863 Arguments :
9864 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9865
9866 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9867 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009868 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9869 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009870
9871 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9872
9873
9874srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9875 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9876 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9877 server side.
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 yes | no | yes | yes
9880 Arguments :
9881 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9882 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9883 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9884 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9885
9886 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9887 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009888 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9889 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009890
9891 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9892
9893
9894srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9895 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 yes | no | yes | yes
9898 Arguments :
9899 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9900 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9901 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9902 document.
9903
9904 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9905 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009906 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9907 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009908
9909 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9910
9911
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009912stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9913 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009915 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009916
9917 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9918 matched.
9919
9920 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9921 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9922
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009923 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9924 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009926
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009927 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9928 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9929 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9930 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009931
9932 Example :
9933 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9934 backend stats_localhost
9935 stats enable
9936 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9937
9938 Example :
9939 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9940 backend stats_auth
9941 stats enable
9942 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9943 stats admin if TRUE
9944
9945 Example :
9946 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9947 userlist stats-auth
9948 group admin users admin
9949 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9950 group readonly users haproxy
9951 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9952
9953 backend stats_auth
9954 stats enable
9955 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9956 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9957 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9958 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9959
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009960 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9961 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9962 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009963
9964
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009965stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9966 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009968 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009969 Arguments :
9970 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9971
9972 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9973
9974 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9975 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9976 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9977 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9978 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9979 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9980
9981 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9982 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9983 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009984 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009985
9986 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9987 report using "stats scope".
9988
9989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9991 unobvious parameters.
9992
9993 Example :
9994 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9995 backend public_www
9996 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9997 stats enable
9998 stats hide-version
9999 stats scope .
10000 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010002 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10003 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10004
10005 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10006 backend private_monitoring
10007 stats enable
10008 stats uri /admin?stats
10009 stats refresh 5s
10010
10011 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10012
10013
10014stats enable
10015 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010017 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010018 Arguments : none
10019
10020 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10021 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10022 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10023 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10024 - stats auth : no authentication
10025 - stats scope : no restriction
10026
10027 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10028 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10029 unobvious parameters.
10030
10031 Example :
10032 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10033 backend public_www
10034 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10035 stats enable
10036 stats hide-version
10037 stats scope .
10038 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010040 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10041 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10042
10043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10044 backend private_monitoring
10045 stats enable
10046 stats uri /admin?stats
10047 stats refresh 5s
10048
10049 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10050
10051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010052stats hide-version
10053 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010055 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010056 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010057
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010058 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10059 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10060 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10061 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10062 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10063 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010065 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10066 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10067 unobvious parameters.
10068
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010069 Example :
10070 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10071 backend public_www
10072 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010073 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010074 stats hide-version
10075 stats scope .
10076 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010077 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010078 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10079 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010080
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010081 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10082 backend private_monitoring
10083 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010084 stats uri /admin?stats
10085 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010086
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010088
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010089
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010090stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10092 Access control for statistics
10093
10094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10095 no | no | yes | yes
10096
10097 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10098 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10099 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10100 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10101 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10102 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10103
10104 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10105 instance.
10106
10107 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10108 about ACL usage.
10109
10110
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010111stats realm <realm>
10112 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010115 Arguments :
10116 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10117 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10118 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10119
10120 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10121 using a backslash ('\').
10122
10123 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10124 only related to authentication.
10125
10126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10128 unobvious parameters.
10129
10130 Example :
10131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10132 backend public_www
10133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10134 stats enable
10135 stats hide-version
10136 stats scope .
10137 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010138 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10141
10142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10143 backend private_monitoring
10144 stats enable
10145 stats uri /admin?stats
10146 stats refresh 5s
10147
10148 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10149
10150
10151stats refresh <delay>
10152 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 Arguments :
10156 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10157 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10158 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10159 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10160 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10161 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10162
10163 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10164 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10165 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010166 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010167
10168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10170 unobvious parameters.
10171
10172 Example :
10173 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10174 backend public_www
10175 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10176 stats enable
10177 stats hide-version
10178 stats scope .
10179 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010180 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010181 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10182 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10183
10184 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10185 backend private_monitoring
10186 stats enable
10187 stats uri /admin?stats
10188 stats refresh 5s
10189
10190 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10191
10192
10193stats scope { <name> | "." }
10194 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010197 Arguments :
10198 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10199 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10200 section in which the statement appears.
10201
10202 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10203 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10204 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10205 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10206 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10207 exists.
10208
10209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10211 unobvious parameters.
10212
10213 Example :
10214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10215 backend public_www
10216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10217 stats enable
10218 stats hide-version
10219 stats scope .
10220 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010221 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10224
10225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10226 backend private_monitoring
10227 stats enable
10228 stats uri /admin?stats
10229 stats refresh 5s
10230
10231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010233
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010234stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010235 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010237 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010238
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010239 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010240 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10241
10242 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10243 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10244
10245 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10246 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010247 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010248
10249 Example :
10250 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10251 backend private_monitoring
10252 stats enable
10253 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10254 stats uri /admin?stats
10255 stats refresh 5s
10256
10257 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10258 global section.
10259
10260
10261stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010262 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10264 yes | yes | yes | yes
10265 Arguments : none
10266
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010267 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010268 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10269 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10270 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10271 - IP (socket, server)
10272 - cookie (backend, server)
10273
10274 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10275 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010276 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010277
10278 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10279
10280
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010281stats show-modules
10282 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10284 yes | yes | yes | yes
10285 Arguments : none
10286
10287 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10288 values as a tooltip.
10289
10290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10292 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10293
10294 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10295
10296
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010297stats show-node [ <name> ]
10298 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010301 Arguments:
10302 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10303 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10304
10305 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10306 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010307 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010308
10309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10311 unobvious parameters.
10312
10313 Example:
10314 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10315 backend private_monitoring
10316 stats enable
10317 stats show-node Europe-1
10318 stats uri /admin?stats
10319 stats refresh 5s
10320
10321 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10322 section.
10323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324
10325stats uri <prefix>
10326 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010329 Arguments :
10330 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10331 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10332 query string.
10333
10334 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10335 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10336 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10337 possible to reach it in the application.
10338
10339 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010340 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10342 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10343 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10344 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10345
10346 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10347 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10348 an address or a port to statistics only.
10349
10350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10352 unobvious parameters.
10353
10354 Example :
10355 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10356 backend public_www
10357 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10358 stats enable
10359 stats hide-version
10360 stats scope .
10361 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010362 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010363 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10364 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10365
10366 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10367 backend private_monitoring
10368 stats enable
10369 stats uri /admin?stats
10370 stats refresh 5s
10371
10372 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10373
10374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010375stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10376 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010379
10380 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010381 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010382 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010383 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010384 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10385
10386 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10387 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10388 the "stick-table" statement.
10389
10390 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10391 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10392 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10393 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10394 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10395
10396 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10397 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10398 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10399 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10400 transformation rules.
10401
10402 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10403 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10404 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10405 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10406 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10407 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10408 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10409
10410 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10411 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10412 ACL based conditions.
10413
10414 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10415 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10416 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10417 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10418
10419 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10420 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10421 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10422 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10423
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010424 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10425 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010426 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010427
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010428 Example :
10429 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10430 # last 30 minutes
10431 backend pop
10432 mode tcp
10433 balance roundrobin
10434 stick store-request src
10435 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10436 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10437 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10438
10439 backend smtp
10440 mode tcp
10441 balance roundrobin
10442 stick match src table pop
10443 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10444 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10445
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010446 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010447 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010448
10449
10450stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10451 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10453 no | no | yes | yes
10454
10455 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10456 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10457 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10458 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10459
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010460 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10461 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010463
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010464 Examples :
10465 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010466 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010467
10468 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10469 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10470 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10471
10472
10473 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10474 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10475 backend http
10476 mode http
10477 balance roundrobin
10478 stick on src table https
10479 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10480 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10481 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10482
10483 backend https
10484 mode tcp
10485 balance roundrobin
10486 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10487 stick on src
10488 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10489 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10490
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010491 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010492
10493
10494stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10495 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10497 no | no | yes | yes
10498
10499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010500 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010501 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010503 server is selected.
10504
10505 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10506 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10507 the "stick-table" statement.
10508
10509 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10510 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10511 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10512 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10513 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10514 address.
10515
10516 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10517 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10518 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10519 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10520 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10521 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10522 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10523 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10524 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10525 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10526
10527 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10528 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10529 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10530 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10531 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10532 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10533 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10534
10535 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10536 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10537 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10538 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10539
10540 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10541 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10542 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10543 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10544 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10545 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010546 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10547 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10548 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10549 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10550 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10551 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010552
10553 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10554 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10555 the request.
10556
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010557 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10558 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010559 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010560
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010561 Example :
10562 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10563 # last 30 minutes
10564 backend pop
10565 mode tcp
10566 balance roundrobin
10567 stick store-request src
10568 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10569 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10570 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10571
10572 backend smtp
10573 mode tcp
10574 balance roundrobin
10575 stick match src table pop
10576 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10577 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10578
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010579 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010580 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010581
10582
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010583stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010584 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10585 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010586 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010588 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010589
10590 Arguments :
10591 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10592 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10593 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10594 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10595
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010596 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10597 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10598 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10599 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10600
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010601 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10602 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10603 instance.
10604
10605 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10606 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10607 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10608 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10609 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10610 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010611 to 32 characters.
10612
10613 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10614 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10615 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010616 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010617 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10618 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010619
10620 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010621 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10622 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010623 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10624 increase.
10625
10626 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010627 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10628 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10629 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010630
10631 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10632 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10633 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10634 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010635 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010636 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10637 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10638 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10639 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10640 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10641 parameter (see below).
10642
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010643 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10644 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10645 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10646 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10647 soft restart.
10648
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010649 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10650 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010651
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010652 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10653 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10654 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10655 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010656 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010657 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010658 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10659 if not expiration delay is specified.
10660
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010661 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10662 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10663 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10664 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010665 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10666 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10667 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10668 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10669 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10670 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10671 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10672 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10673 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10674 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10675 types and their arguments.
10676
10677 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10678 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10679 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10680 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10681
10682 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10683 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10684 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010685 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010686
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010687 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10688 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10689 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010690 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010691 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010692 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010693
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010694 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10695 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10696 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10697 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10698
10699 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10700 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10701 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10702 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10703 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10704 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10705
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010706 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10707 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10708 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10709 they were received.
10710
10711 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10712 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10713 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10714 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10715 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10716
10717 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10718 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10720 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10721 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10722
10723 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10724 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10725 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10726
10727 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10728 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10729 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10730 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10731 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10732
10733 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10734 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10735 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10736 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10737 the client side.
10738
10739 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10740 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10741 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10742 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10743 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10744 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10745 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10746
10747 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10748 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10749 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10750 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10751 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10752 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010753 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010754
10755 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10758 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10759 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10760 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10761
10762 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010763 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010764 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10765 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10766
10767 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10770 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10771 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10772 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10773 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10774 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10775 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10776 recommended for better fairness.
10777
10778 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010779 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010780 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10781 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10782
10783 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10784 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10786 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10787 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10788 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10789 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10790 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10791 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10792 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010793
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010794 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10795 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010796 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10797 reference it.
10798
10799 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10800 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010801 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10802 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10803 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010804
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010805 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10806 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10807 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10808 something that can be ignored.
10809
10810 Example:
10811 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10812 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10813 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10814 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10815
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010816 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010817 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010818
10819
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010820stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010821 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10823 no | no | yes | yes
10824
10825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010826 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010827 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010828 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010829 server is selected.
10830
10831 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10832 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10833 the "stick-table" statement.
10834
10835 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10836 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10837 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10838 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10839
10840 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10841 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10842 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10843 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10844 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10845 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010846 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010847 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10848 rules.
10849
10850 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10851 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10852 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10853 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10854 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10855 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10856 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10857
10858 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10859 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10860 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10861 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10862
10863 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10864 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10865 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10866 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10867 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10868 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010869 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10870 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10871 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10872 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10873 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10874 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10875 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10876 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10877 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010878
10879 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10880
10881 Example :
10882 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10883 backend https
10884 mode tcp
10885 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010886 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010887 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010888
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010889 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10890 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10891
10892 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10893 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10894 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10895
10896 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10897 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010898
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010899 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10900 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10901 # at offset 44.
10902
10903 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10904 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10905
10906 # Learn on response if server hello.
10907 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010908
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010909 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10910 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10911
10912 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10913 extraction.
10914
10915
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010916tcp-check comment <string>
10917 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10918 it fails.
10919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10920 yes | no | yes | yes
10921
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010922 Arguments :
10923 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10924 rule fails.
10925
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010926 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10927 user-friendly error reporting.
10928
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010929 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10930 "tcp-check expect".
10931
10932
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010933tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10934 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010935 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010936 Opens a new connection
10937 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010938 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010939
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010940 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010941 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10942
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010943 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010944 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010945
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010946 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010947 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10948 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010949 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010950
10951 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010952
10953 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10954
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010955 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10956
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010957 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10958
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010959 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10960
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010961 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10962 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10963 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10964 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10965
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010966 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10967 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10968 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10969 haproxy -vv.
10970
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010971 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010972
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010973 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10974 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10975 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10976
10977 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10978 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10979 of the sequence.
10980
10981 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10982 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10983 do.
10984
10985 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10986 unset-var or comment rules.
10987
10988 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010989 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10990 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10991 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10992 option tcp-check
10993 tcp-check connect
10994 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10995 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10996 tcp-check send \r\n
10997 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10998 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10999 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11000 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11001 tcp-check send \r\n
11002 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11003 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11004
11005 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11006 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011007 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011008 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11009 tcp-check connect port 143
11010 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11011 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11012
11013 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11014
11015
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011016tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011017 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011018 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011019 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011022 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011023
11024 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011025 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11026
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011027 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11028 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11029 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11030 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11031 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11032 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11033 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11034 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11035 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11036 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11037
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011038 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011039 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11040 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011041 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11042 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11043 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11044
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011045 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11046 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11047 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011048 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11049 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
11050 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
11051 example 404 with disable-on-404
11052 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11053 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011054 By default "L7OK" is used.
11055
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011056 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11057 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011058 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
11059 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11060 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11061 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11062 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11063 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011064
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011065 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011066 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011067 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11068 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11069 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11070 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011071 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11072
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011073 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11074 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11075 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11076 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11077
11078 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11079 informational message reported in logs if an error
11080 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11081 log-format string.
11082
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011083 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11084 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11085 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11086 followed by some converters.
11087
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011088 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11089 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11090 with the usual backslash ('\').
11091 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011092 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011093 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11094 used upper or lower case.
11095
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011096 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11097
11098 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11099 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11100 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11101 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11102 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11103 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11104 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11105 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11106
11107 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11108 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11109 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11110 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11111 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11112 expression.
11113
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011114 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11115 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11116 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11117 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11118 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11119 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11120
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011121 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11122 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11123 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11124 this exact hexadecimal string.
11125 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11126
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011127 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11128 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11129 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11130 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11131 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11132 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11133 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11134 size.
11135
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011136 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11137 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11138 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11139 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11140 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11141 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11142 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11143 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11144 in a binary string before matching the response's
11145 buffer.
11146
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011147 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
11148 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
11149 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11150 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11151 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11152 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11153 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11154 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11155 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11156 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11157 the null character.
11158
11159 Examples :
11160 # perform a POP check
11161 option tcp-check
11162 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11163
11164 # perform an IMAP check
11165 option tcp-check
11166 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11167
11168 # look for the redis master server
11169 option tcp-check
11170 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011171 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011172 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11173 tcp-check expect string role:master
11174 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11175 tcp-check expect string +OK
11176
11177
11178 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
11179 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
11180
11181
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011182tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11183tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11184 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11185 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011187 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011188
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011189 Arguments :
11190 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11191
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011192 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11193 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011194
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011195 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11196 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011197
11198 Examples :
11199 # look for the redis master server
11200 option tcp-check
11201 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11202 tcp-check expect string role:master
11203
11204 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
11205 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
11206
11207
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011208tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11209tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11210 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11211 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011213 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011214
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011215 Arguments :
11216 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011217
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011218 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11219 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011220
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011221 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11222 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11223 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011224
11225 Examples :
11226 # redis check in binary
11227 option tcp-check
11228 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11229 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11230
11231
11232 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
11233 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
11234
11235
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011236tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011237 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011239 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011240
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011241 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011242 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11243 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11244 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11245 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11246 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11247 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11248 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11249 and '-'.
11250
11251 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11252
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011253 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011254 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11255
11256
11257tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011258 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011260 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011261
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011262 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011263 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11264 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11267 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11269 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11270 and '-'.
11271
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011272 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011273 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11274
11275
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011276tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11277 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11279 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011280 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011281 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11282 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011284 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011285
11286 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11287 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011288 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11289 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11290 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11291 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11292 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11293 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011295 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11296 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11297 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11298 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011299
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011300 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011301 - accept :
11302 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11303 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11304 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011306 - reject :
11307 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11308 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11309 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11310 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11311 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11312 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11313 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11314 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11315 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11316 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11317 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011318 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011319
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011320 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11321 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11322 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11323 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11324 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11325 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11326 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11327 hosts.
11328
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011329 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11330 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11331 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11332 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11333 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11334 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11335 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11336 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11337
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011338 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11339 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11340 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11341 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11342 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11343 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11344 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11345 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11346 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011347 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11348 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011349
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011350 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011351 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011352 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11353 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11354 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011355 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011356 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011357 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11358 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11359 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11360 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11361 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11362 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11363 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011365 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011366 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011368 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011369 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11370 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11371 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011372
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011373 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11374 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11375 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11376 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011378 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11379 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11380 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11381 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11382 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011383 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11384 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11385 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11386 layer7 information is extracted.
11387
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011388 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11389 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11390 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11391 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11392 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011393
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011394 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11395 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11396 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11397 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11398
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011399 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11400 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11401 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11402 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11403
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011404 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11405 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11406 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11407 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11408 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011409
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011410 - set-src <expr> :
11411 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11412 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11413 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011414 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011415
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011416 Arguments:
11417 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11418 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011419
11420 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011421 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11422
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011423 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11424 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011425
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011426 - set-src-port <expr> :
11427 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11428 expression.
11429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011430 Arguments:
11431 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11432 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011433
11434 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011435 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11436
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011437 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11438 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11439 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011440
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011441 - set-dst <expr> :
11442 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11443 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11444 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11445 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11446 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11447
11448 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11449 followed by some converters.
11450
11451 Example:
11452
11453 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11454 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11455
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011456 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11457 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11458
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011459 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11460 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11461 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11462 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11463
11464
11465 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11466 followed by some converters.
11467
11468 Example:
11469
11470 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11471
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011472 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11473 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11474 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11475
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011476 - "silent-drop" :
11477 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011478 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011479 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11480 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11481 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11482 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11483 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11485 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011486 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11487 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011488 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011489 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11490 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11491 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11492 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011494 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11495 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11496 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011497
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011498 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11499 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11500 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011502 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011503 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011504 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011505
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011506 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11507 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11508 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011509
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011510 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011511 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11512 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011513
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011514 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11515
11516 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11517
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011518 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11519
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011520 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011521
11522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011523tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11524 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011526 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011527 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011528 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11529 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011531 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011533 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011534 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11535 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11536 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11537 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011538
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011539 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11540 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11541 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11542 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011543 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11544 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11545 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11546 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11547 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11548 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011549 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011550 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011551
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011552 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11553 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11554 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11555 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011556
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011557 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011558 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011559 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011560 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11561 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011562 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011563 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011564 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011565 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011566 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011567 - set-dst <expr>
11568 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011569 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011570 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011571 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011572 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011573 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011574
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011575 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11576 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011577 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11578 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011579
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011580 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11581 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11582 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11583 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11584 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11585 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011587 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011588 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11589 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011590
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011591 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11592 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11593 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11594 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11595 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11596 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11597
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011598 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011599 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11600 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11601 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11602 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11603 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11604 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11605 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11606 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11607 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11608 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011609
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011610 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011611 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11612 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11613 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011614
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011615 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11616 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11617
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011618 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011619 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11620 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011621
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011622 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11623 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011627 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011628 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011629 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011630 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11631 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011632 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011633 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11634 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011635
11636 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11637 followed by some converters.
11638
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011639 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11640 <var-name>.
11641
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011642 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11643 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11644 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11645 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11646 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11647
11648 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11649 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11650 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11651 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11652 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11653 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11654 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11655 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11656 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11657 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11658 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11659
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011660 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11661 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11662 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11663 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11664 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11665
11666 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11667
11668 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11669
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011670 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11671 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11672 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11673 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11674 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11675 evaluated.
11676
11677 Example:
11678 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11679
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011680 Example:
11681
11682 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011683 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011684
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011685 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011686 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11687 # and reject everything else.
11688 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11689 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011690 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011691 tcp-request content reject
11692
11693 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011694 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11695 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11696 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011697 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011698
11699 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11700 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11701 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011702 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011703 tcp-request content reject
11704
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011705 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011706 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011707 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011708 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011709 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11710 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011711
11712 Example:
11713 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11714 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011715 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011716
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011717 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011718 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011719
11720 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011721 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011722 # protecting all our sites
11723 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011724 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11725 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011726 ...
11727 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11728
11729 backend http_dynamic
11730 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011731 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011732 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011733 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011734 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011735 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011736 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011738 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011739
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011740 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11741 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011742
11743
11744tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011747 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011748 Arguments :
11749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11751 as explained at the top of this document.
11752
11753 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11754 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11755 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11756 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11757 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11758
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011759 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11760 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11761 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11762 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11763
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011764 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11765 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011766 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011767 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011768 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11769 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11770 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11771 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011772
11773 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11774 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11775 it pass through unaffected.
11776
11777 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11778 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11779 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011780 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011781 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11782 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011783 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11784 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11785 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011787 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011788 "timeout client".
11789
11790
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011791tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11792 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11794 no | no | yes | yes
11795 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011796 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11797 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011798
11799 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011801 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011802 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11803 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011804 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11805 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011806
11807 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11808
11809 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11810 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11811 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11812 inserted.
11813
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011814 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011815 - accept :
11816 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11817 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11818 the rules evaluation.
11819
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011820 - close :
11821 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11822 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11823 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11824 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11825 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11826 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011827 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011828 protocols.
11829
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011830 - reject :
11831 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11832 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011833 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011834
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011835 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11836 Sets a variable.
11837
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011838 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11839 Unsets a variable.
11840
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011841 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11842 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11843 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11844 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11845
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011846 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11847 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11848 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11849 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11850
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011851 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11852 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11853 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11854 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11855 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011856
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011857 - "silent-drop" :
11858 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011859 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011860 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11861 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11862 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11863 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11864 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011865 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11866 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011867 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11868 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011869 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011870 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11871 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11872 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11873 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11874
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011875 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11876 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11877
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011878 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11879 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11880 for changing the default action to a reject.
11881
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011882 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11883 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11884 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11885 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011886 period.
11887
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011888 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11889 declared inline.
11890
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11892 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11895 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011896 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011897 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011898 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011899 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11900 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011901 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011902 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11903 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011904
11905 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11906 followed by some converters.
11907
11908 Example:
11909
11910 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11911
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011912 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11913 <var-name>.
11914
11915 Example:
11916
11917 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11918
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011919 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11920 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11921 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11922 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11923 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11924
11925 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11926
11927 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11928
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011929 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11930
11931 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11932
11933
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011934tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11935 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11937 no | yes | yes | no
11938 Arguments :
11939 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11940 below.
11941
11942 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11943
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011944 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011945 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11946 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11947 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11948 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11949 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11950 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11951 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011952 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011953 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11954 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11955 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11956 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11957 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11958 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11959 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11960 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11961 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11962 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11963 instead.
11964
11965 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11966 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11967 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11968 rules which may be inserted.
11969
11970 Several types of actions are supported :
11971 - accept : the request is accepted
11972 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11973 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11974 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011975 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011976 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011977 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011978 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011979 - silent-drop
11980
11981 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11982 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11983 sections for a complete description.
11984
11985 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11986 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11987 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11988
11989 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11990 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11991 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11992 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11993 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11994
11995 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11996 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11997
11998 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11999 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12000 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12001
12002 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12003 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12004 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12005
12006 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12007 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12008 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12009
12010 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12011 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12012 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12013
12014 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12015
12016 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12017
12018
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012019tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12020 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12022 no | no | yes | yes
12023 Arguments :
12024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12026 as explained at the top of this document.
12027
12028 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12029
12030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012031timeout check <timeout>
12032 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12033 established.
12034
12035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12036 yes | no | yes | yes
12037 Arguments:
12038 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12039 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12040 as explained at the top of this document.
12041
12042 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12043 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012044 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012045 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012046 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12047 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12048 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012049
12050 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12051 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12052
12053 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12054 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012055 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012056
12057 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12058 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12059 forget about it.
12060
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012061 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12062 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012063
12064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012065timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012066 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12068 yes | yes | yes | no
12069 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012070 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012071 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12072 as explained at the top of this document.
12073
12074 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12075 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12076 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012077 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12078 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12079 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12080 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012081 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12082 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12083 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012084 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012085 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012086 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12087 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012088 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12089 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012090
12091 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12092 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12093 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12094 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012095 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012096 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12097
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012098 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012099
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012100 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012102
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012103timeout client-fin <timeout>
12104 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12106 yes | yes | yes | no
12107 Arguments :
12108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12110 as explained at the top of this document.
12111
12112 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12113 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12114 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12115 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12116 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12117 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12118 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012119 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12120 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12121 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012122
12123 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12124 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12125 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12126
12127 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12128
12129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012130timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012131 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12133 yes | no | yes | yes
12134 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012135 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012136 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12137 as explained at the top of this document.
12138
12139 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012140 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012141 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012142 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012143 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12144 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012145
12146 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12147 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12148 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12149 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012150 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012151 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12152
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012153 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012155
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012156timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12157 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12159 yes | yes | yes | yes
12160 Arguments :
12161 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12162 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12163 as explained at the top of this document.
12164
12165 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12166 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12167 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12168 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12169 once the request has started to present itself.
12170
12171 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12172 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12173 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12174 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12175 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12176
12177 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12178 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12179 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12180 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12181
12182 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12183 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012184 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012185 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12186 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012187 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012188
12189 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12190 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12191 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12192 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12193
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012194 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12195 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012196 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12197
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012198 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12199
12200
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012201timeout http-request <timeout>
12202 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012204 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012205 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012206 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12208 as explained at the top of this document.
12209
12210 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12211 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12212 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12213 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12214 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12215 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12216 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012217 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12218 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12219 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12220 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012221 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012222 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12223 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012224
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012225 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12226 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12227 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12228 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12229 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012230 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012231
12232 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12233 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012235 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12236 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12237
12238 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012239 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12240 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12241 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012242
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012243 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012244 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012245
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012246
12247timeout queue <timeout>
12248 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12250 yes | no | yes | yes
12251 Arguments :
12252 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12253 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12254 as explained at the top of this document.
12255
12256 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12257 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12258 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12259 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12260 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12261
12262 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12263 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12264 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12265 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12266
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012267 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012268
12269
12270timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012271 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12273 yes | no | yes | yes
12274 Arguments :
12275 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12276 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12277 as explained at the top of this document.
12278
12279 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12280 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12281 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12282 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12283 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12284 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12285 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12286
12287 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12288 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12289 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12290 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12291 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012292 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012293 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012294 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12295 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012296 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12297 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012298
12299 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12301 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12302 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012303 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012304 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12305
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012306 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012307
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012308
12309timeout server-fin <timeout>
12310 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12312 yes | no | yes | yes
12313 Arguments :
12314 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12315 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12316 as explained at the top of this document.
12317
12318 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12319 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12320 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12321 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12322 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12323 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12324 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12325 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12326 situations, it should not be needed.
12327
12328 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12329 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12330 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12331
12332 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12333
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012334
12335timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012336 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12338 yes | yes | yes | yes
12339 Arguments :
12340 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12341 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12342 as explained at the top of this document.
12343
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012344 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12345 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12346 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012347
12348 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12349 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12350 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12351 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012352 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012353
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012354 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012355
12356
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012357timeout tunnel <timeout>
12358 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12360 yes | no | yes | yes
12361 Arguments :
12362 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12363 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12364 as explained at the top of this document.
12365
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012366 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012367 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12368 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12369 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012370 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12371 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012372 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12373 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12374 specified.
12375
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012376 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12377 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12378 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12379 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12380 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12381 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12382 state.
12383
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012384 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12385 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12386 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12387 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012388 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012389
12390 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12391 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12392 forget about it.
12393
12394 Example :
12395 defaults http
12396 option http-server-close
12397 timeout connect 5s
12398 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012399 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012400 timeout server 30s
12401 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12402
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012403 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012404
12405
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012406transparent (deprecated)
12407 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012410 Arguments : none
12411
12412 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12413 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12414 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12415 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12416 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12417 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12418 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12419 appropriate server.
12420
12421 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12422
12423 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12424 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12425
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012426 See also: "option transparent"
12427
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012428unique-id-format <string>
12429 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12431 yes | yes | yes | no
12432 Arguments :
12433 <string> is a log-format string.
12434
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012435 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12436 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12437 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12438 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012439
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012440 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12441 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12442 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12443 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12444 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12445 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12446 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12447 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012448
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012449 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12450 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012451
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012452 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012453
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012454 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012455
12456 will generate:
12457
12458 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12459
12460 See also: "unique-id-header"
12461
12462unique-id-header <name>
12463 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12465 yes | yes | yes | no
12466 Arguments :
12467 <name> is the name of the header.
12468
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012469 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12470 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012471
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012472 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012473
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012474 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012475 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12476
12477 will generate:
12478
12479 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12480
12481 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012482
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012483use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012484 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12486 no | yes | yes | no
12487 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012488 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12489 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012490
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012491 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12492 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012493
12494 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12495 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12496 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012497 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012498 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012499 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12500 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012501
12502 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12503 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12504 assign the backend.
12505
12506 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12507 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12508 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12509 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12510 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12511 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12512
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012513 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012514 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012515 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12516 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12517 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12518
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012519 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12520 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12521 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12522 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12523 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12524 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12525 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12526 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12527 cannot be forced from the request.
12528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012529 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012530 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12531 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12532
12533 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12534 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012535
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012536use-fcgi-app <name>
12537 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12539 no | no | yes | yes
12540 Arguments :
12541 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12542
12543 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012544
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012545use-server <server> if <condition>
12546use-server <server> unless <condition>
12547 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12549 no | no | yes | yes
12550 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012551 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12552 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012553
12554 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12555
12556 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12557 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12558 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12559
12560 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12561 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12562 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12563 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12564 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12565 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12566 matches will assign the server.
12567
12568 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12569 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12570 with the next rules until one matches.
12571
12572 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12573 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12574 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12575 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12576
12577 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12578 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12579 stripped.
12580
12581 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12582 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012583 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12584 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12585 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012586
12587 Example :
12588 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12589 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12590 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12591 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012592 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012593 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012594 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012595 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12596 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12597
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012598 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12599 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12600 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12601 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012602 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012603 and we fall back to load balancing.
12604
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012605 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012606
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126085. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012609--------------------------
12610
12611The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12612depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12613settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12614written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12615described in this section.
12616
12617
126185.1. Bind options
12619-----------------
12620
12621The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12622as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12623no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12624parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12625while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12626provided immediately after the setting name.
12627
12628The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12629
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012630accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12631 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12632 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12633 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12634 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12635 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12636 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12637 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12638 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12639 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012640 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12641 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12642 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012644accept-proxy
12645 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012646 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12647 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012648 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12649 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12650 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12651 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012653 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12654 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012655 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12656 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012657
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012658allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012659 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012660 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012661 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012662 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12663 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012664
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012665alpn <protocols>
12666 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12667 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12668 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012669 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012670 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012671 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12672 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12673 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12674 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12675 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12676 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12677 preference, like below :
12678
12679 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012680
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012681backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012682 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012683 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12684
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012685curves <curves>
12686 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12687 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12688 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12689 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12690 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12691 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12692
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012693ecdhe <named curve>
12694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012695 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12696 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012697
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012698ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12700 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12701 client's certificate.
12702
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012703ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12705 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12706 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12707 error is ignored.
12708
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012709ca-sign-file <cafile>
12710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12711 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12712 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12713 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12714 'generate-certificates' for details.
12715
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012716ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12718 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12719 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12720 'generate-certificates' for details.
12721
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012722ca-verify-file <cafile>
12723 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12724 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12725 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12726 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12727 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12728
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012729ciphers <ciphers>
12730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12731 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012732 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012733 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012734 information and recommendations see e.g.
12735 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12736 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12737 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12738
12739ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12741 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12742 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12743 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012744 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12745 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012746
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012747crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012748 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12749 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12750 to verify client's certificate.
12751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012752crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12754 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12755 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12756 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12757 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012758 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12759 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012760
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012761 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12762 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12763
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012764 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12765 are loaded.
12766
12767 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012768 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12769 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12770 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12771 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12772 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12773 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12774 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012775 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012776
12777 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12778 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12779 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12780 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012781 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12782 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012783
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012784 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012785
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012786 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012787 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012788 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12789 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012790 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12791 clients).
12792
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012793 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12794 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12795 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12796 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12797 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12798 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12799 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12800 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12801 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12802 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12803 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12804 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12805 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12806
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012807 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12808 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12809 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12810 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12811 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12812
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012813 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12814 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12815 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12816 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012817
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012818 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12819 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12820 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012821
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012822crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012823 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012824 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012825 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012826 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012827
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012828crt-list <file>
12829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012830 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12831 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012832
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012833 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12834
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012835 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12836 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12837 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12838 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12839 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012840
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012841 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012842 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12843 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12844 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12845 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12846 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012847 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12848 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12849 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012850
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012851 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12852 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12853 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012854
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012855 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12856
Joao Morais5ae6bfc2020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012857 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12858 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12859 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12860 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12861 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12862 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12863 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12864 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012865
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012866 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraiscaaa46c2020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012867 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012868 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012869 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012870 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012871 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012872
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012873defer-accept
12874 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12875 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12876 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012877 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012878 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12879 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12880 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12881 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12882 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12883 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12884 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12885
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012886expose-fd listeners
12887 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12888 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012889 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12890 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012891 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012892
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012893force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012894 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012895 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012896 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012897 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012898
12899force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012900 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012901 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012902 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012903
12904force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012905 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012906 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012907 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012908
12909force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012910 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012911 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012912 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012913
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012914force-tlsv13
12915 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12916 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012917 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012918
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012919generate-certificates
12920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12921 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12922 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12923 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12924 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12925 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12926 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12927 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12928 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12929 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12930 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12931
12932 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12933 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012934 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012935 certificate is used many times.
12936
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012937gid <gid>
12938 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12939 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12940 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12941 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12942 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12943
12944group <group>
12945 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12946 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12947 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12948 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12949 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12950
12951id <id>
12952 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12953 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12954 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12955 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12956
12957interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012958 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12959 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12960 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12961 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12962 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12963 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012964 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12965 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12966 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12967 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12968 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12969 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012970
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012971level <level>
12972 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12973 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12974 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012975 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012976 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12977 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12978 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012979 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012980 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012982 all counters).
12983
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012984severity-output <format>
12985 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12986 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12987 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12988 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12989 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12990 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12991 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12992 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12993 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12994 rfc5424 convention.
12995
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012996maxconn <maxconn>
12997 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12998 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12999 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13000 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13001 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13002 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13003 eat all memory.
13004
13005mode <mode>
13006 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13007 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13008 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13009 UNIX sockets.
13010
13011mss <maxseg>
13012 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13013 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13014 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13015 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13016 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13017 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13018 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13019 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13020 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13021 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13022 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13023
13024name <name>
13025 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13026 page.
13027
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013028namespace <name>
13029 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13030 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13031 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13032 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013034nice <nice>
13035 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13036 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13037 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13038 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13039 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13040 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13041 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13042 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13043 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13044 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13045 one for an RDP socket.
13046
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013047no-ca-names
13048 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13049 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013050 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013051
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013052no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013054 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013055 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013056 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013057 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13058 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013059
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013060no-tls-tickets
13061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13062 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13063 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013064 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13065 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013066 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13067 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13068 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013069
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013070no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013072 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013073 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013074 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013075 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13076 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013077
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013078no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013080 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013081 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013082 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013083 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13084 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013085
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013086no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013088 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013089 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013090 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013091 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13092 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013093
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013094no-tlsv13
13095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13096 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13097 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13098 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013099 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13100 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013101
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013102npn <protocols>
13103 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13104 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13105 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013106 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013107 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013108 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13109 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13110 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13111 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13112 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013113
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013114prefer-client-ciphers
13115 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13116 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13117 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013118 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13119 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13120 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013121
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013122process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013123 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013124 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013125 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013126 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13127 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13128 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13129 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013130 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013131 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13132 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13133 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13134 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13135 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013136
13137 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13138
13139 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13140 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13141 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13142 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13143 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13144 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13145 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13146 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013147
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013148proto <name>
13149 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13150 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13151 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13152 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013153 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013154 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013155 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013156 h2" on the bind line.
13157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013158ssl
13159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013160 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013161 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13162 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013163 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13164 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013165
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013166ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13167 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013168 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13169 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13170 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013171 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13172
13173ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013174 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13175 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13176 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13177 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013178
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013179strict-sni
13180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13181 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13182 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13183 See the "crt" option for more information.
13184
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013185tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013186 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013187 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13188 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013189 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013190 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13191 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13192 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13193 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13194 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13195 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13196 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13197
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013198tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013199 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013200 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13201 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13202 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13203 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13204 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13205 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13206 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013207 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13208 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13209 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013210
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013211tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13212 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013213 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13214 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13215 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13216 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13217 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13218 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13219 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13220 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13221 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13222 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013223 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13224 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13225
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013226transparent
13227 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13228 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13229 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13230 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13231 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13232 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13233 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13234 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13235 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13236 so check for support with your vendor.
13237
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013238v4v6
13239 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13240 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13241 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13242 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013243 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013244
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013245v6only
13246 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13247 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13248 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013249 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13250 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013251
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013252uid <uid>
13253 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13254 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13255 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13256 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13257 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13258
13259user <user>
13260 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13261 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13262 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13263 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13264 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13265
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013266verify [none|optional|required]
13267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13268 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13269 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13270 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13271 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013272 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13273 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13274 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13275 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013276
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013278------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013280The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13281which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13282arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13283settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13284after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13285Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13286address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013288 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013289 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013290
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013291Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13292keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013294The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013295
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013296addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013297 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013298 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13299 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13300 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13301 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13302 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013303
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013304agent-check
13305 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013306 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013307 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13308 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13309 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013310
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013311 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013312 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013313 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13314 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13315 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013316
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013317 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13318 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13319 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13320 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13321 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013322
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013323 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013324 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013325
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013326 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13327 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13328 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013329
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013330 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13331 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13332 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013333
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013334 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013335 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13336 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13337 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13338 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013339 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013340 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013342 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13343 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013344
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013345 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13346 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13347 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13348 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13349 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13350 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13351 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13352 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13353 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013354
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013355 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13356 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013357 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13358 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13359 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013360 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013361
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013362 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013363 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013364
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013365agent-send <string>
13366 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13367 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13368 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13369 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13370 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13371
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013372agent-inter <delay>
13373 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13374 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13375
13376 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13377 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13378 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13379 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13380 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13381 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13382 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13383 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13384 of backends use the same servers.
13385
13386 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13387
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013388agent-addr <addr>
13389 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13390
13391 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13392 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13393 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13394 hostname, it will be resolved.
13395
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013396agent-port <port>
13397 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13398
13399 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13400
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013401allow-0rtt
13402 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013403 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13404 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013405
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013406alpn <protocols>
13407 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13408 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13409 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013410 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013411 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13412 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13413 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13414 now obsolete NPN extension.
13415 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13416 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13417
13418 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013420backup
13421 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13422 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13423 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13424 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013425 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13426 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013427
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013428ca-file <cafile>
13429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13430 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13431 server's certificate.
13432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013433check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013434 This option enables health checks on a server:
13435 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13436 considered available.
13437 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13438 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13439 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13440 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13441 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13442 set.
13443 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13444 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13445 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13446 exchanges succeed.
13447
13448 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13449 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13450 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13451 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13452 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013453 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013454 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13455
13456 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13457 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13458
13459 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13460 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13461
13462 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13463 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13464 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13465 available.
13466
13467 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13468 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13469 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13470
13471 Example:
13472 # simple tcp check
13473 backend foo
13474 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13475 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13476 backend foo
13477 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13478 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13479 backend foo
13480 option tcp-check
13481 tcp-check connect
13482 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013483
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013484check-send-proxy
13485 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13486 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13487 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13488 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13489 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13490 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13491 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13492
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013493check-alpn <protocols>
13494 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13495 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13496 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13497
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013498check-proto <name>
13499 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13500 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13501 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13502 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013503 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013504 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13505 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13506
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013507check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013508 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013509 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13510 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013511
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013512check-ssl
13513 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13514 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13515 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13516 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013517 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013518 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13519 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013520 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013521 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13522 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013523
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013524check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013525 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013526 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13527 for normal traffic.
13528
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013529ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13531 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13532 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013533 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13534 information and recommendations see e.g.
13535 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13536 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13537 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013538
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013539ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13541 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13542 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13543 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013544 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13545 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13546 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013548cookie <value>
13549 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13550 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13551 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13552 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13553 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13554 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13555 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13556
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013557crl-file <crlfile>
13558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13559 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13560 to verify server's certificate.
13561
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013562crt <cert>
13563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13564 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13565 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13566 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13567 certificate request.
13568
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013569disabled
13570 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13571 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13572 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13573 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13574 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013575 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013576
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013577enabled
13578 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13579 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13580 default value.
13581 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13582 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013584error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013585 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13586 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13587 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013589 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013591fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013592 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13593 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13594 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13595
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013596force-sslv3
13597 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13598 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013599 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013600 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013601
13602force-tlsv10
13603 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013604 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013605 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013606
13607force-tlsv11
13608 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013609 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013610 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013611
13612force-tlsv12
13613 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013614 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013615 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013616
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013617force-tlsv13
13618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13619 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013622id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013623 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13624 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13625 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013626
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013627init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13628 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13629 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013630 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013631 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13632 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13633 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13634 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13635 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13636 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13637 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13638 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13639 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013640 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013641 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13642 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13643 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13644 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13645 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13646 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013647 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013648
13649 Example:
13650 defaults
13651 # never fail on address resolution
13652 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013654inter <delay>
13655fastinter <delay>
13656downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013657 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13658 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13659 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13660 between checks depending on the server state :
13661
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013662 Server state | Interval used
13663 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13664 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13665 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13666 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13667 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13668 or yet unchecked. |
13669 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13670 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13671 | "inter" otherwise.
13672 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013674 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13675 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13676 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13677 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013678 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13679 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13680 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13681 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13682 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013683
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013684log-proto <logproto>
13685 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13686 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13687 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13688 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013690maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013691 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13692 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013693 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13694 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013695 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13696 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13697 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13698 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13699
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013700 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13701 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13702 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13703 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13704 than 50 concurrent requests.
13705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013706maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013707 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13708 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13709 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13710 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013711 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13712 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13713 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13714 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13715 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13716 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13717 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013718
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013719max-reuse <count>
13720 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13721 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13722 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13723 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13724 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13725 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13726 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13727 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13728
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013729minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013730 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13731 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13732 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13733 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13734 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13735 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013736 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013737 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013738
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013739namespace <name>
13740 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13741 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13742 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13743 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13744
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013745no-agent-check
13746 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13747 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13748 default value.
13749 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13750 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13751
13752no-backup
13753 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13754 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13755 default value.
13756 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13757 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13758
13759no-check
13760 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13761 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13762 default value.
13763 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13764 "default-server" "check" setting.
13765
13766no-check-ssl
13767 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13768 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13769 default value.
13770 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13771 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13772
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013773no-send-proxy
13774 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13775 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13776 default value.
13777 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13778 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13779
13780no-send-proxy-v2
13781 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13782 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13783 default value.
13784 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13785 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13786
13787no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13788 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13789 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13790 default value.
13791 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13792 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13793
13794no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13795 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13796 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13797 default value.
13798 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13799 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13800
13801no-ssl
13802 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13803 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13804 default value.
13805 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13806 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13807
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013808no-ssl-reuse
13809 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13810 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13811 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13812 and for paranoid users.
13813
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013814no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013815 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13816 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013817 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013818
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013819 Supported in default-server: No
13820
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013821no-tls-tickets
13822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13823 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13824 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013825 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13826 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013827 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13828 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13829 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013830 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013831
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013832no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013833 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013834 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13835 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013836 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13837 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013838 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013839
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013840 Supported in default-server: No
13841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013842no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013843 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013844 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13845 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013846 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13847 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013849
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013850 Supported in default-server: No
13851
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013852no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013853 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013854 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13855 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013856 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13857 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013858 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013859
13860 Supported in default-server: No
13861
13862no-tlsv13
13863 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13864 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13865 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13866 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13867 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013868 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013869
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013870 Supported in default-server: No
13871
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013872no-verifyhost
13873 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13874 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13875 default value.
13876 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13877 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013878
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013879no-tfo
13880 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13881 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13882 default value.
13883 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13884 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13885
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013886non-stick
13887 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13888 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13889 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13890
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013891npn <protocols>
13892 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13893 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13894 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013895 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013896 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13897 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13898 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013900observe <mode>
13901 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13902 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13903 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13904 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13905 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13906 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013907 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013908
13909 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013911on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013912 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13913 Currently, four modes are available:
13914 - fastinter: force fastinter
13915 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13916 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13917 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13918 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13919
13920 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13921
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013922on-marked-down <action>
13923 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13924 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013925 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13926 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13927 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13928 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13929 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13930 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13931 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13932 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013933
13934 Actions are disabled by default
13935
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013936on-marked-up <action>
13937 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13938 Currently one action is available:
13939 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13940 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13941 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13942 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13944 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013945 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13946 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13947
13948 Actions are disabled by default
13949
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013950pool-low-conn <max>
13951 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13952 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13953 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13954 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13955 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13956 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13957 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13958 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13959 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13960 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13961 applying to "http-reuse".
13962
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013963pool-max-conn <max>
13964 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13965 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13966 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13967 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13968 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13969 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13970
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013971pool-purge-delay <delay>
13972 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013973 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013974 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013976port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013977 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13978 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13979 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13980 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13981 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13982 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13983
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013984proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013985 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13986 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13987 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13988 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013989 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013990 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013992redir <prefix>
13993 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13994 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13995 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13996 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13997 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13998 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13999 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14000 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014001 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014003 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14004 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14005 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14006 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14007
14008 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014010rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014011 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14012 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14013 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14014
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014015resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14016 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14017 server.
14018
14019 Available options:
14020
14021 * allow-dup-ip
14022 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14023 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14024 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14025 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14026 For such case, simply enable this option.
14027 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14028
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014029 * ignore-weight
14030 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14031 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14032 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14033
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014034 * prevent-dup-ip
14035 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14036 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14037 same fqdn.
14038 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14039
14040 Example:
14041 backend b_myapp
14042 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14043 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14044 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14045
14046 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14047 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14048 it
14049 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14050 different address
14051
14052 Default value: not set
14053
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014054resolve-prefer <family>
14055 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14056 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14057 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14058 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14059
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014060 Default value: ipv6
14061
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014062 Example:
14063
14064 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014065
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014066resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014067 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014068 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014069 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14071 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014072 configured network, another address is selected.
14073
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014074 Example:
14075
14076 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014077
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014078resolvers <id>
14079 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14080 hostname.
14081
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014082 Example:
14083
14084 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014085
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014086 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014087
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014088send-proxy
14089 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14090 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14091 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14092 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014093 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14094 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14095 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14096 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14097 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14098 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14099 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14100 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14101 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14102 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014103 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14104 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014105
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014106send-proxy-v2
14107 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14108 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14109 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14110 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014111 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14112 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14113 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14114 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014115
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014116proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014117 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14118 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14119
14120 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14121 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14122 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14123 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14124 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14125 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14126 connection is supported).
14127 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14128 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14129 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14130 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14131 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14132 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14133 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014134
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014135send-proxy-v2-ssl
14136 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14137 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14138 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14139 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14140 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14141 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14142 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014143 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14144 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014145
14146send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14147 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14148 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14149 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14150 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14151 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14152 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14153 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14154 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14156 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014158slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014159 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14160 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14161 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14162 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14163 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14164 parameters :
14165
14166 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14167 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14168
14169 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14170 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14171 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14172 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14173
14174 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14175 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14176 seen as failed.
14177
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014178sni <expression>
14179 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14180 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14181 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14182 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014183 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14184 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014185 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014186 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14187 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014188
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014189source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014190source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014191source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014192 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14193 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14194 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14195 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14196
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014197 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14198 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14199 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14200 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14201 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14202 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14203 server.
14204
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014205 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14206 specifying the source address without port(s).
14207
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014208ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014209 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14210 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14211 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14212 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14213 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14214 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014215 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14216 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014217
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014218ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14219 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14220 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14221 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14222
14223ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14224 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14225 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14226 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14227
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014228ssl-reuse
14229 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14230 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14231 default value.
14232 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14233 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14234
14235stick
14236 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14237 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14238 default value.
14239 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14240 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014241
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014242socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014243 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014244 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14245 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14246
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014247tcp-ut <delay>
14248 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14249 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14250 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014251 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014252 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14253 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14254 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14255 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14256 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14257 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14258 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14259 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14260 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14261
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014262tfo
14263 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14264 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14265 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14266 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14267 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014268 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014270track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014271 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14272 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14273 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14274 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014275 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14276
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014277tls-tickets
14278 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14279 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14280 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014281 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14282 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14283 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014284 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014285 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014286
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014287verify [none|required]
14288 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014289 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014290 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14291 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014292 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014293 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14294 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14295 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14296 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14297 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14298 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14299 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14300 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014301
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014302verifyhost <hostname>
14303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014304 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14305 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14306 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14307 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14308 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14309 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14310 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14311 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014313weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014314 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14315 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14316 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014317 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14318 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14319 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14320 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14321 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14322 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014323
14324
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143255.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14326-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014327
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014328HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14329using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14330configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014331This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14332can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14333workload.
14334This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14335resolution at run time.
14336Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14337carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14338
14339
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143405.3.1. Global overview
14341----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014342
14343As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14344different steps of the process life:
14345
14346 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14347 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14348 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14349
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014350 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14351 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014352
14353A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14354 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14355 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14356 resolution to know this new IP.
14357
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014358When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014359HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014360SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14361from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14362will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14363will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014364
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014365A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014366 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014367 first valid response.
14368
14369 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14370 servers return an error.
14371
14372
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143735.3.2. The resolvers section
14374----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014375
14376This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014377HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14378contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014379
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014380When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14381uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14382is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14383answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14384
14385When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014386used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014387
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014388 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14389 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14390 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014391
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014392 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14393 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014394
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014395 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14396 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14397 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014398
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014399For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14400following scenarios are possible:
14401
14402 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14403 ignored
14404
14405 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14406 applied
14407
14408 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14409 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14410
14411 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14412 retries the query with a new type
14413
14414 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14415 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014416
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014417As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14418a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014419<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014420
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014421
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014422resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014423 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014424
14425A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14426
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014427accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014428 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014429 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014430 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14431 by RFC 6891)
14432
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014433 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14434
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014435nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14436 DNS server description:
14437 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14438 <ip> : IP address of the server
14439 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14440
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014441parse-resolv-conf
14442 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14443 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14444 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14445
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014446hold <status> <period>
14447 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14448 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014449 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014450 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014451 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14452 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14453 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14454
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014455 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014456
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014457resolve_retries <nb>
14458 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14459 giving up.
14460 Default value: 3
14461
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014462 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14463 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14464 type.
14465
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014466timeout <event> <time>
14467 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14468 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14469 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014470 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14471 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014472 Default value: 1s
14473 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014474 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014475 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014476 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14477 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14478
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014479 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014480
14481 resolvers mydns
14482 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14483 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014484 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014485 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014486 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014487 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014488 hold other 30s
14489 hold refused 30s
14490 hold nx 30s
14491 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014492 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014493 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014494
14495
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200144966. Cache
14497---------
14498
14499HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14500(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14501RAM.
14502
14503The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14504this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14505
14506If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14507independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14508when we try to allocate a new one.
14509
14510The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14511
14512It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14513"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14514for more details.
14515
14516When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14517replaced by "<CACHE>".
14518
14519
145206.1. Limitation
14521----------------
14522
14523The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14524
14525- If the response is not a 200
14526- If the response contains a Vary header
14527- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14528- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonea8e0812020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014529- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14530 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14531 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014532
14533- If the request is not a GET
14534- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14535- If the request contains an Authorization header
14536
14537
145386.2. Setup
14539-----------
14540
14541To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14542the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14543
14544
145456.2.1. Cache section
14546---------------------
14547
14548cache <name>
14549 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14550 size of cache is mandatory.
14551
14552total-max-size <megabytes>
14553 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14554 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14555
14556max-object-size <bytes>
14557 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14558 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14559 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14560
14561max-age <seconds>
14562 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14563 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14564 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14565 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14566 default.
14567
14568
145696.2.2. Proxy section
14570---------------------
14571
14572http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14573 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14574 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14575 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14576 after this one.
14577
14578http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14579 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14580 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14581 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14582 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14583
14584
14585Example:
14586
14587 backend bck1
14588 mode http
14589
14590 http-request cache-use foobar
14591 http-response cache-store foobar
14592 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14593
14594 cache foobar
14595 total-max-size 4
14596 max-age 240
14597
14598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145997. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14600----------------------------------
14601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014602HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14604The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14605these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14606but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14607data called patterns.
14608
14609
146107.1. ACL basics
14611---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014612
14613The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14614content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14615from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14616simple :
14617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014619 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14621 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14624adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014625
14626In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014628 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014629
14630This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14631Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14632and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014633an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14634conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14635as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14636are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014637
14638ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14639'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14640which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14641
14642There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14643performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14646specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14647this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014648methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14649ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650
14651Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14652 - boolean
14653 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14654 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14655 - string
14656 - data block
14657
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014658Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14659converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14660would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14661The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14662which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14663
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014664Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14665keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14666fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14667which are summarized in the table below :
14668
14669 +---------------------+-----------------+
14670 | Sample or converter | Default |
14671 | output type | matching method |
14672 +---------------------+-----------------+
14673 | boolean | bool |
14674 +---------------------+-----------------+
14675 | integer | int |
14676 +---------------------+-----------------+
14677 | ip | ip |
14678 +---------------------+-----------------+
14679 | string | str |
14680 +---------------------+-----------------+
14681 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14682 +---------------------+-----------------+
14683
14684Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14685matching method, see below.
14686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14688 - boolean
14689 - integer or integer range
14690 - IP address / network
14691 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14692 - regular expression
14693 - hex block
14694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014695The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14696
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014697 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14698 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014699 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014700 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014701 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014702 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014703 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14706read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14707if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14708lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14709will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14710beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14711a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14712lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14713exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14714
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014715The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14716parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14717ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14718a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14719check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14720
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014721The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14722socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14723file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14726loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14727
14728 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14729
14730In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14731the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14732case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14733as well.
14734
14735The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14736sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14737do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14738methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14739is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014740obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14742default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14743that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14744string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14745
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014746The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14747By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14748string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14749resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14750server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014751waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014752flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14753function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14756sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14757be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014758
14759 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14760 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14762 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14763 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14764 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014765
14766 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14767 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014769
14770 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014772
14773 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014775
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014777 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14778
14779 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14780 binary or string samples.
14781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14783 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14786 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14787 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14790 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14793 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14796 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14799 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014800 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14803 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14804 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014805
14806For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14807request, it is possible to do :
14808
14809 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14810
14811In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14812buffer, one would use the following acl :
14813
14814 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14815
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014816On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14817possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14818
14819 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14822criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14823method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14824to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14825criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14826the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014829the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14830For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014832 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14833 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14834 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14835 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014836
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014837
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014838The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14839types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14840combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14841brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14842default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 +-------------------------------------------------+
14845 | Input sample type |
14846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014847 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14849 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014851 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014853 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014855 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014857 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014859 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014861 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014863 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014865 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014867 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014869 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014871 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14873 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14874 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014875
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148777.1.1. Matching booleans
14878------------------------
14879
14880In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14881Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14882When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14883that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14884
14885Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14886return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14887"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148907.1.2. Matching integers
14891------------------------
14892
14893Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14894enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14895to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14896
14897Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14898matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14899lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014900
14901For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14902unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14903representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14904
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014905As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14906two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14907instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14908ranges and operators.
14909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014910For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014911operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14912Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14913of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014915Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014916
14917 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14918 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14919 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14920 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14921 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014923For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014924
14925 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14926
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014927This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14928
14929 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149327.1.3. Matching strings
14933-----------------------
14934
14935String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14936different forms :
14937
14938 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014939 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940
14941 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014942 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943
14944 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14945 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14946
14947 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14948 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14949
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014950 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14952 matches.
14953
14954 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14955 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14956 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014957
14958String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14959exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14960characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14961string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14962to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014963before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014964
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014965Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14966(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14967Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14968
14969Example:
14970 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14971 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14972
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14975---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014976
14977Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14978they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14979possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14980passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14981the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014982the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14983match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014984
14985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149867.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14987-------------------------------------
14988
14989It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14990not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14991a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14992to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14993digits may be used upper or lower case.
14994
14995Example :
14996 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14997 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14998
14999
150007.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15001---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015002
15003IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15004netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15005within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015006host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015007difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15008at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15009does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15010parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015011
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015012The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15013abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15014
15015 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15016 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15017 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15018 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15019 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15020 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15021 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15022 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15023
15024Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15025192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15026
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015027IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15028Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15029trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15030IPv6 patterns.
15031
15032HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15033following situations :
15034 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15035 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15036 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15037 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15038 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15039 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15040 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15041 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15042 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15043 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045
150467.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15047----------------------------------
15048
15049Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15050combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15051
15052 - AND (implicit)
15053 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15054 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15061indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015063For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15064"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15065requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15066is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15067
15068 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015069 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15070 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15071 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072
15073To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15074and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15075
15076 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15077 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15078 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15079 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15080
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015081 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15083 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15084 use_backend www if host_www
15085
15086It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15087expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15088be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15089the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15090
15091 The following rule :
15092
15093 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015094 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095
15096 Can also be written that way :
15097
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015098 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015099
15100It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15101to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15102simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15103sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15104good use is the following :
15105
15106 With named ACLs :
15107
15108 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15109 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15110 monitor fail if site_dead
15111
15112 With anonymous ACLs :
15113
15114 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15115
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015116See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15117keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118
15119
151207.3. Fetching samples
15121---------------------
15122
15123Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15124against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15125sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15126ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15127of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15128available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15129
15130This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15131Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15132compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15133deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15134
15135The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15136matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15137method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15138indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15139
15140As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15141when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15142mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15143the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15144ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15145
15146Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15147multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15148when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015149incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15150are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15152all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15153
15154Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15155 - name
15156 - name(arg1)
15157 - name(arg1,arg2)
15158
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015159
151607.3.1. Converters
15161-----------------
15162
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015163Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15164of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15165is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15166was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015167has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015168unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15169
15170These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15171sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15172the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015173support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015174
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015175A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15176support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15177supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15178(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15179bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015182
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001518351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15184 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15185 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15186 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15187 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15188 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15189
15190 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015191 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15192 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015193 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15194 frontend http-in
15195 bind *:8081
15196 default_backend servers
15197 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15198 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15199
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015200add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015201 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015202 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015203 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15204 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015205 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015206 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15207 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15209 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015211 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015212
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015213aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15214 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15215 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15216 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15217 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15218 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15219 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15220
15221 Example:
15222 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15223 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015225and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015226 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015227 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015228 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15229 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015236 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015237
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015238b64dec
15239 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15240 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15241
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015242base64
15243 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015245 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15246
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015247bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015248 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015249 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015250 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015251 presence of a flag).
15252
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015253bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15254 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15255 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015256 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015257
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015258concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15259 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15260 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15261 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15262 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15263 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15264 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15265 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15266 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15267 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15268 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015269 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015270 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015271 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15272 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015273
15274 Example:
15275 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15276 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15277 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015278 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015279 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15280
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015281cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015282 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15283 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015284
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015285crc32([<avalanche>])
15286 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15287 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15288 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15289 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15290 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15291 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15292 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15293 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15294 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15295 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015296 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15297
15298crc32c([<avalanche>])
15299 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15300 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15301 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15302 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15303 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15304 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15305 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15306 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015307
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015308cut_crlf
15309 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15310 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15311 updated.
15312
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015313da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015314 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15315 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15316 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15317 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015318 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015319 configuration language.
15320
15321 Example:
15322 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015323 bind *:8881
15324 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015325 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015326
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015327debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15328 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15329 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15330 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15331 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15332 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15333 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15334 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15335 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15336 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15337 printable sample types.
15338
15339 Example:
15340 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015341
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015342digest(<algorithm>)
15343 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15344 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15345
15346 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15347 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015349div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015350 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15351 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015352 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015353 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15354 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015355 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015356 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15357 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15358 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15359 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015360 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015361 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015362
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015363djb2([<avalanche>])
15364 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15365 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15366 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15367 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15368 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15369 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15370 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015371 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15372 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015373
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015374even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015375 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015376 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15377
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015378field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15379 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15380 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15381 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15382 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15383 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15384 fields.
15385
15386 Example :
15387 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15388 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15389 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15390 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15391 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015392
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015393hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015395 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015396 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015397 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015398
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015399hex2i
15400 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015401 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015402
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015403htonl
15404 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15405 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15406 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15407 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15408
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015409hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15410 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15411 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15412 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15413 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15414
15415 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15416 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15417
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015418http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015419 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15420 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015421 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15422 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15423 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15424 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15425 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15426 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15427 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15428 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015430iif(<true>,<false>)
15431 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15432 string otherwise.
15433
15434 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015435 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015436
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015437in_table(<table>)
15438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15440 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015441 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015442 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15443
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015444ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15445 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015446 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015447 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15448 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15449 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15450 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15451 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015452
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015453json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015454 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015455 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015456 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015457 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15458 of errors:
15459 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15460 bytes, ...)
15461 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15462 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15463
15464 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15465 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15466 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15467 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15468 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15469 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015470 - "ascii" : never fails;
15471 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15472 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015473 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015474 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015475 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15476 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15477
15478 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015479 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015480
15481 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015482 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015483 capture request header user-agent len 150
15484 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015485
15486 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15487 GET / HTTP/1.0
15488 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15489
15490 Output log:
15491 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15492
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015493language(<value>[,<default>])
15494 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15495 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15496 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15497 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15498 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15499 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15500 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15501 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15502 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015503 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015504 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15505 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015507 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015508
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015509 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15510 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015512 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15513 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15514 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15515 use_backend spanish if es
15516 use_backend french if fr
15517 use_backend english if en
15518 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015519
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015520length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015521 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15522 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15523 type. The result is of type integer.
15524
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015525lower
15526 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15527 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15528 type. The result is of type string.
15529
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015530ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15531 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15532 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15533 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15534 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15535 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15536 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15537
15538 Example :
15539
15540 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015541 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015542 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15543
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015544ltrim(<chars>)
15545 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15546 representation of the input sample.
15547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015548map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15549map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15550map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15551 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15552 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15553 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15554 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15555 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15556 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15557 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15558 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015560 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15561 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15562 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015563
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015564 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015565 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015566
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015567 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15569 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015571 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015573 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15575 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15577 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15579 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015581 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15583 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15585 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15587 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015589
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015590 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15591 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15592 the corresponding match text.
15593
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015594 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15595 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15596 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15597 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15598 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015599
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015600 Example :
15601
15602 # this is a comment and is ignored
15603 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15604 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15605 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15606 | | | `---------- value
15607 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15608 | `---------------------------- key
15609 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15610
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015611mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015612 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15613 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015614 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015615 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15619 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15620 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015622 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015623
15624mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015625 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015626 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15627 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015628 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015629 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015630 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015631 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15632 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15633 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15634 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015635 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015636 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015637
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015638nbsrv
15639 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15640 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15641 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15642 map lookup.
15643
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015644neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015645 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15646 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15647 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15648 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015649
15650not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015651 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015652 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015653 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015654 absence of a flag).
15655
15656odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015657 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015658 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15659
15660or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015661 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015662 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015663 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15664 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015665 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015666 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15667 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15668 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15669 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015671 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015672
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015673protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15674 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15675 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15676 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15677 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15678 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15679 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15680 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15681 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15682 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15683 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15684 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15685
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015686regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015687 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15688 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15689 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15690 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15691 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15692 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15693 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15694 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15695 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015696 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15697 of characters with other ones.
15698
15699 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15700 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15701 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15702 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15703 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15704 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015705
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015706 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015707
15708 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15709 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15710 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015711 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015712
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015713 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15714 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15715
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015716 # capture groups and backreferences
15717 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015718 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015719 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15720
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015721capture-req(<id>)
15722 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15723 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15724
15725 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015726 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15727 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015728
15729capture-res(<id>)
15730 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15731 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15732
15733 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015734 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15735 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015736
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015737rtrim(<chars>)
15738 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15739 of the input sample.
15740
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015741sdbm([<avalanche>])
15742 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15743 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15744 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15745 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15746 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15747 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15748 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015749 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15750 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015751
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015752secure_memcmp(<var>)
15753 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15754 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15755 match.
15756
15757 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15758 performed in constant time.
15759
15760 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15761 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15762
15763 Example :
15764
15765 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15766 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15767 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15768 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15769
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015770set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015771 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15772 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15773 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015774 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015775 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15776 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015777 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015778 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15779 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015780 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015781 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015782
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015783sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015784 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015785 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15786
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015787sha2([<bits>])
15788 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15789 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15790
15791 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15792 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15793
15794 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15795 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15796
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015797srv_queue
15798 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15799 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15800 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15801 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15802 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15803
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015804strcmp(<var>)
15805 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15806 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15807 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15808 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15809 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15810 shorter).
15811
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015812 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15813 strings in constant time.
15814
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015815 Example :
15816
15817 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15818 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15819 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15820
15821
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015822sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015823 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15824 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015825 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015826 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15827 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015828 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015829 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15830 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015831 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015832 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15833 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015834 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015835 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015836
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015837table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15838 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15839 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15840 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15841 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15842 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15843 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15844
15845
15846table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15847 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15848 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15849 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15850 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15851 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15852 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15853
15854table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15855 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15856 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015857 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015858 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15859 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15860
15861table_conn_cur(<table>)
15862 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15863 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15864 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15865 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15866 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15867
15868table_conn_rate(<table>)
15869 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15870 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15871 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15872 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15873 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15874
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015875table_gpt0(<table>)
15876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15878 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15879 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15880 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15881
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015882table_gpc0(<table>)
15883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15886 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15887 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15888
15889table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15893 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15894 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15895 sample fetch keyword.
15896
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015897table_gpc1(<table>)
15898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15900 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15901 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15902 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15903
15904table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15908 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15909 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15910 sample fetch keyword.
15911
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015912table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015916 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15917 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15918
15919table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15922 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15923 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15924 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15925 keyword.
15926
15927table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015931 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15932 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15933
15934table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15937 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15938 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15939 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15940 keyword.
15941
15942table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015946 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15947 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15948 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15949 keyword.
15950
15951table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15952 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15953 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015954 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015955 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15956 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15957 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15958 keyword.
15959
15960table_server_id(<table>)
15961 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15962 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15963 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15964 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15965 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15966 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15967
15968table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015971 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015972 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15973 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15974 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15975 keyword.
15976
15977table_sess_rate(<table>)
15978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15980 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15981 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15982 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15983 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15984 keyword.
15985
15986table_trackers(<table>)
15987 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15988 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15989 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15990 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15991 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15992 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15993 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15994 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15995 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15996 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15997
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015998upper
15999 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16000 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16001 type. The result is of type string.
16002
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016003url_dec([<in_form>])
16004 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16005 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16006 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16007 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16008 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16009 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016010
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016011ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016012 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016013 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16014 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16015 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016016 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16017 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16018 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16019 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016020 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016021 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16022 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016023
16024 Example:
16025 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16026 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16027
16028 message Point {
16029 int32 latitude = 1;
16030 int32 longitude = 2;
16031 }
16032
16033 message PPoint {
16034 Point point = 59;
16035 }
16036
16037 message Rectangle {
16038 // One corner of the rectangle.
16039 PPoint lo = 48;
16040 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16041 PPoint hi = 49;
16042 }
16043
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016044 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16045 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16046 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016047
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016048 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16049 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016050 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016051 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16052
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016053 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016054
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016055 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016056
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016057 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16058 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16059 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016060
16061 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16062 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16063 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16064
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016065 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16066 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16067 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016068
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016069
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016070unset-var(<var name>)
16071 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16072 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16073 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16074 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16075 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16076 response),
16077 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16078 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16079 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16080 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16081
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016082utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16083 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16084 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16085 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16086 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16087 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16088 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16089
16090 Example :
16091
16092 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016093 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016094 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16095
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016096word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16097 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16098 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16099 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016100 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016101 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16102 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16103
16104 Example :
16105 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16106 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16107 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16108 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16109 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016110 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016111
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016112wt6([<avalanche>])
16113 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16114 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16115 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16116 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16117 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16118 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16119 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016120 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16121 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016122
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016123xor(<value>)
16124 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016125 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016126 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016127 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016128 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016129 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16130 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016131 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016132 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16133 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016134 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016135 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016136
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016137xxh32([<seed>])
16138 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16139 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16140 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16141 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16142 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16143 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16144 as cryptographically secure.
16145
16146xxh64([<seed>])
16147 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16148 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16149 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16150 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16151 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16152 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16153 as cryptographically secure.
16154
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016155
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157--------------------------------------------
16158
16159A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16160not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16161"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16162The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16163
16164always_false : boolean
16165 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16166 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16167
16168always_true : boolean
16169 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16170 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16171
16172avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016173 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16175 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16176 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16177 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16178 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16179 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16180 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16181 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16182 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16183 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16184 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16185 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16186 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016189 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16190 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16191 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16192 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016193 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16194
16195be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16197 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16198 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16199 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16200 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016201 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16202 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016203
16204 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16205 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16206 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16210 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16211 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016212 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16214 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016215
16216 Example :
16217 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16218 backend dynamic
16219 mode http
16220 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16221 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016223bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016224 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16225 of the string.
16226
16227bool(<bool>) : bool
16228 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16229 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016233 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16235 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016236
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016237 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016238 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016239 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16240
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016241 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16242 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016243
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016244 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016245 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016247 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016248 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016250 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016251
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016252 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16253 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016255 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016256
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016257cpu_calls : integer
16258 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16259 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16260 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16261 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16262 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16263 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16264
16265cpu_ns_avg : integer
16266 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16267 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16268 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16269 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16270 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16271 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16272 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16273 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16274 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16275 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16276 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16277
16278cpu_ns_tot : integer
16279 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16280 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16281 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16282 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16283 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16284 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16285 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16286 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16287 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16288 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16289 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16290 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16291 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16292
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016293date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016294 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016295
16296 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16297 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16298 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016299 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16300
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016301 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16302 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16303 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16304 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16305 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16306
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016307 Example :
16308
16309 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16310 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016311
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016312 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16313 # millisecond granularity
16314 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16315
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016316date_us : integer
16317 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16318 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16319 from the same timeval structure.
16320
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016321distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16322 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16323 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16324 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16325 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16326 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16327 list of supported tokens.
16328
16329distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16330 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16331 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16332 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16333 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16334 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16335 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16336 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16337 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16338 supported tokens.
16339
16340 Example :
16341 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16342 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16343 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16344 # send large files to the big farm
16345 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16346
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016347env(<name>) : string
16348 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16349 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16350 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16351 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16352 certain way.
16353
16354 Examples :
16355 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16356 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16357
16358 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16359 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16362 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016363 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16364 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016365 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16366 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016367 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16369 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016370
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016371fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16373 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16374 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16378 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16379 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16380 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16381 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16382 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16383 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16384 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016385
16386 Example :
16387 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16388 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16389 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16390 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16391 frontend mail
16392 bind :25
16393 mode tcp
16394 maxconn 100
16395 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16396 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16397 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16398 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016399
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016400hostname : string
16401 Returns the system hostname.
16402
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016403int(<integer>) : signed integer
16404 Returns a signed integer.
16405
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016406ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16407 Returns an ipv4.
16408
16409ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16410 Returns an ipv6.
16411
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016412lat_ns_avg : integer
16413 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16414 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16415 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16416 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16417 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16418 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16419 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16420 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16421 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016422 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16423 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16424 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16425 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16426 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16427 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016428
16429lat_ns_tot : integer
16430 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16431 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16432 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16433 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16434 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16435 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16436 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16437 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16438 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016439 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16440 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16441 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16442 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16443 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016444 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16445 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16446 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16447 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16448 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16449 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16450
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016451meth(<method>) : method
16452 Returns a method.
16453
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016454nbproc : integer
16455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16456 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16457 and debugging purposes.
16458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16461 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16462 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016463 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16464 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16465 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016466
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016467prio_class : integer
16468 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16469 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16470 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16471
16472prio_offset : integer
16473 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16474 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16475 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16476 set-priority-offset".
16477
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016478proc : integer
16479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16480 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16481 debugging purposes.
16482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016484 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16485 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16486 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16488 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16489 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16490 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16491 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16492
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016493rand([<range>]) : integer
16494 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16495 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16496 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16497 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16498 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16499
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016500uuid([<version>]) : string
16501 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16502 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16503 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16506 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16507 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16508 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16509 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16510 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016511 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16512 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16513
16514srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16516 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16517 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16518 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16519 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16520 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16521 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16522
16523 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16524 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525
16526srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16527 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16528 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16529 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016530 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16532 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16533 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16534
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016535srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16536 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16537 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16538 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16539 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16540 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16541 fetch methods.
16542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16544 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16545 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016546 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016547 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16548 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550 overloading servers).
16551
16552 Example :
16553 # Redirect to a separate back
16554 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16555 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16556 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16557
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016558srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16559 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16560 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16561 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16562
16563srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16564 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16565 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16566 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16567
16568srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16569 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16570 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16571 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16572
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016573stopping : boolean
16574 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16575 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16576 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16577
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016578str(<string>) : string
16579 Returns a string.
16580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016581table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16582 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16583 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16584
16585table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16586 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16587 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16588 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16589
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016590thread : integer
16591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16592 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16593 and debugging purposes.
16594
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016595var(<var-name>) : undefined
16596 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016597 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16598 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016599 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016600 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16601 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016602 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016603 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16604 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016605 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016606 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016607
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609----------------------------------
16610
16611The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16612closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16613methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16614sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16615TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016616the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16617counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016618"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16619used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16620can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16621Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16622table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16623tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16624currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016626bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016627 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16628 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16629 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016631be_id : integer
16632 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016633 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16634 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016636be_name : string
16637 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016638 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16639 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641dst : ip
16642 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16643 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16644 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16645 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016646 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16647 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16648 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16649 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16650 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16651 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652
16653dst_conn : integer
16654 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16655 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16656 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16657 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16658 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16659 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16660 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16661 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016662
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016663dst_is_local : boolean
16664 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16665 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16666 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16667 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016668 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016669 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16670 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16671 it only once per connection.
16672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016673dst_port : integer
16674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16675 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16676 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16677 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16678 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16679 an HTTP header.
16680
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016681fc_http_major : integer
16682 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16683 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16684 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16685
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016686fc_pp_authority : string
16687 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16688 if any.
16689
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016690fc_pp_unique_id : string
16691 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16692 if any.
16693
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016694fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16695 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16696 header.
16697
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016698fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16699 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16700 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16701 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16702 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16703 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16704 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16705
16706fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16707 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16708 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16709 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16710 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16711 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16712 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16713
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016714fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016715 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16716 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16717 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16718 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16719
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016720fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016721 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16722 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16723 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16724 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16725
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016726fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016727 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16728 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16729 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16730 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16731
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016732fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016733 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16734 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16735 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16736 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16737
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016738fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016739 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16740 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16741 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16742 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16743
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016744fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016745 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16746 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16747 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16748 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16749
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016750fe_defbe : string
16751 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16752 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754fe_id : integer
16755 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016756 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16758
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016759fe_name : string
16760 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16761 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16762 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016764sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016765sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16766sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16767sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016768 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16769 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16770 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016772sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016773sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16774sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16775sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016776 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16777 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16778 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016780sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016781sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16782sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16783sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016784 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16785 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016786 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16787 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16788 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016789
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016790 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016791 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16792 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016793 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16794 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16795 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016796 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16797 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16798
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016799sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16800sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16801sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16802sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16803 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16804 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16805 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16806 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16807 when a first ACL was verified.
16808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016809sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016810sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16811sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16812sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016813 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016814 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016816sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016817sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16818sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16819sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016820 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16821 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16822 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016824sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016825sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16826sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16827sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016828 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16829 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16830 See also src_conn_rate.
16831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016832sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016833sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16834sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16835sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016836 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016837 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016838
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016839sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16840sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16841sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16842sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16843 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16844 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16845
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016846sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16847sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16848sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16849sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16850 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16851 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016853sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016854sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16855sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16856sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016857 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16858 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16859 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016860 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16861 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16862 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016863
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016864sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16865sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16866sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16867sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16868 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16869 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16870 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16871 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16872 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16873 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016875sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016876sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16877sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16878sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016879 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016880 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16881 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016883sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016884sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16885sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16886sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016887 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16888 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16889 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16890 src_http_err_rate.
16891
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016892sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016893sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16894sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16895sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016896 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016897 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16898 src_http_req_cnt.
16899
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016900sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016901sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16902sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16903sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016904 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16905 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16906 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16907 src_http_req_rate.
16908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016909sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016910sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16911sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16912sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016913 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016914 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16915 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16916 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16917 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016918
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016919 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016920 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16921 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016922 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16923
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016924sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16925sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16926sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16927sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16928 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16929 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16930 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16931 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16932 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16933
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016934sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016935sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16936sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16937sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016938 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16939 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16940 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016941
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016942sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016943sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16944sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16945sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016946 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16947 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16948 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016949
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016950sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016951sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16952sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16953sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016954 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016955 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16956 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16957 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016958 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016959 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016961sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016962sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16963sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16964sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016965 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16966 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16967 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16968 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16969 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016970 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016972sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016973sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16974sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16975sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016976 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16977 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16978 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16979
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016980sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016981sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16982sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16983sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016984 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16985 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016986 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016987 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16988 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16990 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16991 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993so_id : integer
16994 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16995 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16996 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016997
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016998so_name : string
16999 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17000 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17001 strings instead of integers.
17002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017003src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017004 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017005 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17006 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17007 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017008 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17009 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17010 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017011 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17012 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17013 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17014 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17015 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17016 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17017 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017018
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017019 Example:
17020 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17021 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17024 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17025 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17026 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017027 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017029src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17030 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17031 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017032 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017033 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017035src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17036 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17037 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17038 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17039 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17040 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17041 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017042
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017043 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017044 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17045 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17046 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17047 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017048 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017049 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17050 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17051
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017052src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17053 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17054 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17055 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17056 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17057 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17058 was verified.
17059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017061 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017062 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017063 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017064 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017067 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017068 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17069 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017070 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017072src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17073 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17074 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17075 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017076 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017078src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017079 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017080 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017081 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017082 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017083
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017084src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17085 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17086 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17087 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17088 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17089
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017090src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17091 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17093 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17094 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017096src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017097 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017099 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17100 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017101 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17102 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17103 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017104
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017105src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17106 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17107 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17108 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17109 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17110 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17111 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17112 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017115 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017116 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017117 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017118 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017119 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017121src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17122 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17123 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17124 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17125 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017126 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017129 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17131 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017132 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17135 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17136 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17137 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017138 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017139 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17142 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17143 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17144 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017145 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17147 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017148
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017149 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017150 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017151 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017152 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017153
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017154src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17155 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17156 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17157 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17158 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17159 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17160 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17161
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017162src_is_local : boolean
17163 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17164 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17165 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17166 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017167 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017168 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17169 once per connection.
17170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017172 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17173 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17174 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17175 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17176 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017179 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17180 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17181 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17182 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17183 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017185src_port : integer
17186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17187 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17188 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17189 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017191src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017192 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017193 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17194 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17195 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017196 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017198src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17199 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17200 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17201 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17202 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017203 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17206 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17207 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17208 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17209 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17210 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17211 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17212 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17213 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017214
17215 Example :
17216 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17217 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17218 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17219 listen ssh
17220 bind :22
17221 mode tcp
17222 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017223 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017225 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227srv_id : integer
17228 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17229 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017230 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017231
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017232srv_name : string
17233 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17234 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017235 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017236
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172377.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017240The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17241closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17242when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17243usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017244future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017245
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001724651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17247 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17248 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17249 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17250 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17251 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17252
17253 Example :
17254 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17255 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17256 # the request.
17257 frontend http-in
17258 bind *:8081
17259 default_backend servers
17260 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17261 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17262
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017263ssl_bc : boolean
17264 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17265 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017266 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17267 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017268
17269ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17270 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017271 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17272 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017273
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017274ssl_bc_alpn : string
17275 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17276 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017277 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017278 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17279 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17280 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17281 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17282 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017283 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17284 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017285
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017286ssl_bc_cipher : string
17287 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017288 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17289 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017290
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017291ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17292 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17293 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17294 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017295 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017296
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017297ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17298 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17299 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017300 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17301 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017302
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017303ssl_bc_npn : string
17304 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17305 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017306 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017307 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17308 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17309 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17310 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017311 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17312 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017313
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017314ssl_bc_protocol : string
17315 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017316 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17317 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017318
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017319ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017320 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017321 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017322 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17323 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017324
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017325ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17326 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17327 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17328 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017329 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017330
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017331ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17332 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17333 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017334 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17335 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017336
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017337ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17338 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17339 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17340 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017341 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017342
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017343ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17344 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017345 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17346 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017348ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17349 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17350 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17351 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17352 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17353 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17356 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17357 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17358 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17359 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017360
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017361ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017362 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17363 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17364 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17365 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17366 does not support resumed sessions.
17367
Christopher Faulet7a507632020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017368ssl_c_der : binary
17369 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17370 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17371 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373ssl_c_err : integer
17374 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17375 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17376 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17377 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17378 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017379
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017380ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17382 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17383 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17384 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17385 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17386 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17387 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17388 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017389 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17390 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17391 LDAP v3.
17392 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17393 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017395ssl_c_key_alg : string
17396 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17397 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17398 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400ssl_c_notafter : string
17401 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17402 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17403 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405ssl_c_notbefore : string
17406 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17407 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17408 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017409
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017410ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17412 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17413 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17414 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17415 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17416 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17417 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17418 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017419 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17420 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17421 LDAP v3.
17422 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17423 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017425ssl_c_serial : binary
17426 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17427 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17428 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17431 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17432 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17433 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017434 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17435 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17436
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017437 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017438 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017440ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17441 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17442 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17443 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445ssl_c_used : boolean
17446 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17447 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449ssl_c_verify : integer
17450 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17451 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17452 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17453 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455ssl_c_version : integer
17456 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17457 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017458
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017459ssl_f_der : binary
17460 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17461 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17462 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17463
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017464ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17466 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17467 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17468 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017469 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17471 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17472 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017473 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17474 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17475 LDAP v3.
17476 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17477 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017479ssl_f_key_alg : string
17480 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17481 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17482 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484ssl_f_notafter : string
17485 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17487 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017489ssl_f_notbefore : string
17490 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17491 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17492 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017493
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017494ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17496 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17497 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17498 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17499 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17500 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17501 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17502 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017503 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17504 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17505 LDAP v3.
17506 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17507 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017509ssl_f_serial : binary
17510 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17511 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17512 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017513
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017514ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17515 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17516 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17517 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17520 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17521 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17522 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524ssl_f_version : integer
17525 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17526 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17527
17528ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017529 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17530 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17531 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017533 Example :
17534 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17535 listen http-https
17536 bind :80
17537 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17538 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17539
17540ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17541 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17542 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17543
17544ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017545 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17547 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17548 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17549 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17550 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17551 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17552 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17553 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555ssl_fc_cipher : string
17556 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17557 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017558
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017559ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17560 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17561 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017562 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017563
17564ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17565 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17566 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017567 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017568
17569ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17570 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17571 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17572 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017573 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017574 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017575
17576ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17577 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17578 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017579 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017580
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017581ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17582 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17583 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17584 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17585
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017586ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17587 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17588 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17589 transport layer.
17590 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17591 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17592 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17593 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17594
17595ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17596 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17597 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17598 transport layer.
17599 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17600 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17601 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17602 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17603
17604ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17605 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17606 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17607 transport layer.
17608 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17609 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17610 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17611 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17612
17613ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17614 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17615 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17616 transport layer.
17617 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17618 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17619 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17620 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17621
17622ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17623 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17624 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17625 transport layer.
17626 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17627 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17628 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17629 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017632 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17633 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017634 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17635 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17636 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17637 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017638
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017639ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17640 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17641 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17642 wait until the handshake happened.
17643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17645 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017646 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17647 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017648 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017649 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017650
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017651ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017652 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017653 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17654 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017657 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017658 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17659 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17660 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17661 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17662 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17663 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17664 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666ssl_fc_protocol : string
17667 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17668 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017669
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017670ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017671 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017672 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17673 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017674
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017675ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17676 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17677 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17678 transport layer.
17679 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17680 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17681 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17682 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17683
17684ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17685 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17686 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17687 transport layer.
17688 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17689 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17690 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17691 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17692
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017693ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17694 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17695 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17696 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017698ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17699 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17700 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17701 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17702 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017703
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017704ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17705 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17706 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17707 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17708 BoringSSL.
17709
17710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711ssl_fc_sni : string
17712 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17713 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17714 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17715 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17716 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17717
17718 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17719 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17720 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017721 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017722 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017725 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17726 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017728ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17729 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17730 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017731
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017732ssl_s_der : binary
17733 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17734 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17735 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17736
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017737ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17738 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17739 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17740 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17741 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17742 does not support resumed sessions.
17743
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017744ssl_s_key_alg : string
17745 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17746 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17747 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17748
17749ssl_s_notafter : string
17750 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17751 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17752 transport layer.
17753
17754ssl_s_notbefore : string
17755 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17756 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17757 transport layer.
17758
17759ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17760 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17761 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17762 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17763 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17764 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17765 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017766 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17767 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017768 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17769 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17770 LDAP v3.
17771 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17772 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17773
17774ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17775 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17776 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17777 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17778 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17779 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17780 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017781 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17782 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017783 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17784 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17785 LDAP v3.
17786 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17787 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17788
17789ssl_s_serial : binary
17790 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17791 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17792 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17793
17794ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17795 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17796 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17797 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17798
17799ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17800 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17801 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17802 layer.
17803
17804ssl_s_version : integer
17805 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17806 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017807
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178087.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017809------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017811Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17812sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17813only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17814For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17815be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17816can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17817sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17818for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17819content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017822 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017823 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17824 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17827 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017828 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017829 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831req.len : integer
17832req_len : integer (deprecated)
17833 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17834 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17835 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17836 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17837 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17838 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17839 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17840 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017842req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17843 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017844 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17845 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17846 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17847 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017849 ACL alternatives :
17850 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017852req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17853 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17854 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17855 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17856 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017858 ACL alternatives :
17859 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017863req.proto_http : boolean
17864req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17865 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17866 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17867 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17868 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17869 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17870 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17871 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873 Example:
17874 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17875 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17876 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017877 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017879req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17880rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17881 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17882 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17883 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17884 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17885 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17886 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17887 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017889 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17890 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17891 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17892 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17893 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17894 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017896 ACL derivatives :
17897 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017899 Example :
17900 listen tse-farm
17901 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17902 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17903 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17904 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17905 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17906 persist rdp-cookie
17907 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17908 # This is only useful makes sense if
17909 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17910 stick-table type string size 204800
17911 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17912 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17913 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017915 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17916 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017918req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17919rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17920 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17921 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17922 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17923 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925 ACL derivatives :
17926 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017927
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017928req.ssl_alpn : string
17929 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17930 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17931 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17932 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17933 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17934 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017935 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017936
17937 Examples :
17938 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17939 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17940 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017941 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017942 default_backend bk_default
17943
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017944req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17945 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17946 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017947 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17948 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17949 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17950 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17951 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17954req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17955 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17956 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17957 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17958 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17959 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17960 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17961 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963req.ssl_sni : string
17964req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17965 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17966 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17967 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17968 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17969 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017970 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17971 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17972 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17973 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17974 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17975 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17976 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17977 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17978 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980 ACL derivatives :
17981 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017983 Examples :
17984 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17985 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17986 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17987 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17988 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017989
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017990req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17991 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17992 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17993 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17994 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17995 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17996 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17997 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17998 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17999 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018001req.ssl_ver : integer
18002req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18003 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18004 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18005 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18006 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18007 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18008 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18009 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018010 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018011 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013 ACL derivatives :
18014 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018015
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018016res.len : integer
18017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18018 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18019 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18020 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18021 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18022 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18023 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018024 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018026res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18027 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018028 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018029 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018030 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018031 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18034 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18035 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18036 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018037 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18038 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018041
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018042res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18043rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18044 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18045 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18046 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18047 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18048 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18049 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18050 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052wait_end : boolean
18053 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18054 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018055 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018056 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18057 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018058 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018059 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18060 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062 Examples :
18063 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18064 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18065 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18068 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18069 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18070 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18071 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18072 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18073 tcp-request content reject
18074
18075
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180767.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077--------------------------------------
18078
18079It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18080This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18081data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18082its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18083HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18084content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18085to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18086more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18087response are indexed.
18088
18089base : string
18090 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18091 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18092 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18093 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18094 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18095 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18096 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18097 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18098
18099 ACL derivatives :
18100 base : exact string match
18101 base_beg : prefix match
18102 base_dir : subdir match
18103 base_dom : domain match
18104 base_end : suffix match
18105 base_len : length match
18106 base_reg : regex match
18107 base_sub : substring match
18108
18109base32 : integer
18110 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18111 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18112 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018113 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18114 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18115 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116
18117base32+src : binary
18118 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18119 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18120 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18121 per-URL counters.
18122
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018123capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18124 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18125 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18126 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18127
18128capture.req.method : string
18129 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18130 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18131 because it's allocated.
18132
18133capture.req.uri : string
18134 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18135 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18136 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18137 allocated.
18138
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018139capture.req.ver : string
18140 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18141 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18142 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18143
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018144capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18145 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18146 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18147 The first entry is an index of 0.
18148 See also: "capture response header"
18149
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018150capture.res.ver : string
18151 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18152 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18153 persistent flag.
18154
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018155req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018156 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18157 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18158 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018159
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018160req.body_param([<name>) : string
18161 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18162 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18163 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18164 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18165 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18166 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18167 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18168 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18169 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18170 given.
18171
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018172req.body_len : integer
18173 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18174 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018175 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18176 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018177
18178req.body_size : integer
18179 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018180 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18181 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183req.cook([<name>]) : string
18184cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18185 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18186 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18187 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18188 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18189 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18190 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18191 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18192 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18193
18194 ACL derivatives :
18195 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18196 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18197 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18198 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18199 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18200 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18201 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18202 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18205cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18206 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18207 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018209req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18210cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18212 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18213 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18214 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018216cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18217 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18218 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18219 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18220 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018221 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18223 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18224 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18225 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18228 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18229 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18230 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18231 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018232 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18235 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18236 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18237 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18238 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18239 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18240 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18241 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18242 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18245 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18246 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18247 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18248 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18251 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18252 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18253 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18254 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18255 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18256 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18257 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18258 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018259 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018260 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018261 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018263 ACL derivatives :
18264 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18265 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18266 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18267 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18268 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18269 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18270 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18271 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18272
18273req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18274hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18275 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18276 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18277 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18278 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18279 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18280 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18281 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18282 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18283 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18284
18285req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18286hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18287 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18288 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18289 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18290 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18291 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018292 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18294 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18295
18296req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18297hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18298 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18299 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18300 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18301 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18302 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18303 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18304 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18305
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018306req.hdrs : string
18307 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18308 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18309 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18310 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18311
18312req.hdrs_bin : binary
18313 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18314 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18315 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18316 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18317 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18318 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18319
18320 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018321
Christopher Faulet26167842020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018322 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18323 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18326 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18327 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18328 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18329 basic auth is supported.
18330
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018331http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18332 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18333 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18334 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18335 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18337 basic auth is supported.
18338
18339 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018340 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18341 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18342 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18343 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018345http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018346 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18347 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18348 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018349
18350http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018351 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18352 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18353 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018354
18355http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018356 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18357 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18358 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018361 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18362 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018363 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18364 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366method : integer + string
18367 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18368 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18369 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18370 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18371 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18372 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18373 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375 ACL derivatives :
18376 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378 Example :
18379 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18380 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18381 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383path : string
18384 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18385 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18386 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18387 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18388 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018389 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392 ACL derivatives :
18393 path : exact string match
18394 path_beg : prefix match
18395 path_dir : subdir match
18396 path_dom : domain match
18397 path_end : suffix match
18398 path_len : length match
18399 path_reg : regex match
18400 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018401
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018402pathq : string
18403 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18404 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18405 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18406 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18407 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18408 result in both cases.
18409
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018410query : string
18411 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18412 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18413 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18414 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018415 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018416 which stops before the question mark.
18417
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018418req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18419 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18420 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18421 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18422 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424req.ver : string
18425req_ver : string (deprecated)
18426 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18427 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18428 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018430 ACL derivatives :
18431 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018432
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018433res.body : binary
18434 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18435 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18436 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18437 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18438
18439res.body_len : integer
18440 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18441 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18442 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18443 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18444
18445res.body_size : integer
18446 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18447 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18448 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18449 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18450 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18451 based expect rules.
18452
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018453res.cache_hit : boolean
18454 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18455 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18456
18457res.cache_name : string
18458 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18459 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18460 empty string.
18461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462res.comp : boolean
18463 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18464 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18465 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467res.comp_algo : string
18468 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18469 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18470 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472res.cook([<name>]) : string
18473scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18474 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18475 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018476 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18477 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018479 ACL derivatives :
18480 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18483scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18484 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18485 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018486 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18487 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018489res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18490scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18491 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18492 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018493 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18494 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18497 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18498 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18499 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18500 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18501 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18502 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18503 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18504 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018505 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18508 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18509 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18510 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18511 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018512 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18513 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18516shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18517 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18518 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18519 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18520 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18521 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18522 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18523 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018524 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18525 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018527 ACL derivatives :
18528 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18529 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18530 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18531 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18532 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18533 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18534 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18535 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18536
18537res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18538shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18539 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18540 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18541 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18542 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018543 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18546shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18547 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18548 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18549 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18550 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18551 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018552 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18553 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018554
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018555res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18556 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18557 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18558 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018559 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18560 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018562res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18563shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18564 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18565 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18566 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18567 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18568 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018569 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18570 based expect rules.
18571
18572res.hdrs : string
18573 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18574 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18575 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18576 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18577 based expect rules.
18578
18579res.hdrs_bin : binary
18580 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18581 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18582 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18583 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18584 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18585 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18586 (length of 0 for both).
18587
18588 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18589
18590 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18591 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593res.ver : string
18594resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18595 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018596 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18597 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599 ACL derivatives :
18600 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18603 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18604 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018605 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018608 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18609 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018611status : integer
18612 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18613 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018614 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18615 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018616
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018617unique-id : string
18618 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18619 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18620 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18621 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18622 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18623 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018625url : string
18626 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18627 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18628 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18629 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18630 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18631 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18632 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018634 ACL derivatives :
18635 url : exact string match
18636 url_beg : prefix match
18637 url_dir : subdir match
18638 url_dom : domain match
18639 url_end : suffix match
18640 url_len : length match
18641 url_reg : regex match
18642 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644url_ip : ip
18645 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18646 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18647 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18648 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18649 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18650 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18651 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653url_port : integer
18654 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18655 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18656 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18657 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018658
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018659urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18660url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018661 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18662 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018663 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18664 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18665 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18666 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018667 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18668 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018669 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18670 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672 ACL derivatives :
18673 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18674 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18675 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18676 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18677 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18678 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18679 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18680 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018681
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683 Example :
18684 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18685 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18686 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18687 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018688
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018689urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18691 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18692 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018693
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018694url32 : integer
18695 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18696 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18697 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18698 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18699 is an unsigned integer.
18700
18701url32+src : binary
18702 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18703 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18704 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18705
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018706
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200187077.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018708---------------------------------------
18709
18710This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18711used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18712purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18713There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18714or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18715any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18716for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18717
18718internal.htx.data : integer
18719 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18720 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18721
18722internal.htx.free : integer
18723 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18724 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18725
18726internal.htx.free_data : integer
18727 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18728 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18729
18730internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18731 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18732 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18733 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18734
18735internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18736 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18737 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18738
18739internal.htx.size : integer
18740 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18741 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18742
18743internal.htx.used : integer
18744 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18745 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18746 direction.
18747
18748internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18749 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18750 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18751 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18752 of the special value :
18753 * head : The oldest inserted block
18754 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018755 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018756
18757internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18758 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18759 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18760 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18761 integer or one of the special value :
18762 * head : The oldest inserted block
18763 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018764 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018765
18766internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18767 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18768 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18769 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18770 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18771
18772 * head : The oldest inserted block
18773 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018774 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018775
18776internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18777 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18778 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18779 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18780 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18781
18782 * head : The oldest inserted block
18783 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018784 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018785
18786internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18787 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18788 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18789 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18790 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18791
18792 * head : The oldest inserted block
18793 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018794 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018795
18796internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18797 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18798 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18799 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18800 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18801
18802 * head : The oldest inserted block
18803 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018804 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018805
18806internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18807 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18808 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18809 it returns false.
18810
18811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200188127.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018813---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018815Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18816every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018817order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018819ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18820---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018821FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018822HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018823HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18824HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018825HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18826HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18827HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18828HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18829LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018830METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018831METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018832METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18833METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18834METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18835METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018836METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018837METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018838RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018839REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018840TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018841WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18842---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018843
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188458. Logging
18846----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018847
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018848One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18849provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18850very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18851provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18852state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018853to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018854headers.
18855
18856In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18857about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18858send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18859
18860 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18861 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18862 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18863 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18864 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018865 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018866 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018867
18868The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18869allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18870as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18871while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18872real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18873delay.
18874
18875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188768.1. Log levels
18877---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018878
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018879TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018880source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018881HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18882in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18883track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18884syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18885about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018886
18887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188888.2. Log formats
18889----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018890
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018891HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018892and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18893slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18894options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018895
18896 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18897 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18898 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18899 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18900 extents.
18901
18902 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18903 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18904 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18905 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18906 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18907
18908 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18909 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18910 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18911 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18912 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18913
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018914 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18915 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18916 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18917 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18918
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018919 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018921Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18922specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18923field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18924servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18925always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18926identifier.
18927
18928Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18929 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18930 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18931 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18932 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18933
18934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189358.2.1. Default log format
18936-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018937
18938This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18939as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18940format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18941
18942 Example :
18943 listen www
18944 mode http
18945 log global
18946 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18947
18948 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18949 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18950 (www/HTTP)
18951
18952 Field Format Extract from the example above
18953 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18954 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18955 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18956 4 'to' to
18957 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18958 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18959
18960Detailed fields description :
18961 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18962 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18963 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18964 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18965 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18966 and processed the connection.
18967 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18968
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018969In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18970"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18971connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18972
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018973It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18974will eventually disappear.
18975
18976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189778.2.2. TCP log format
18978---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018979
18980The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18981is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18982information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18983counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18984emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18985environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18986the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18987sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018988specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18989not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18990fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18991marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018992
18993 Example :
18994 frontend fnt
18995 mode tcp
18996 option tcplog
18997 log global
18998 default_backend bck
18999
19000 backend bck
19001 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19002
19003 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19004 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19005 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19006
19007 Field Format Extract from the example above
19008 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19009 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19010 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19011 4 frontend_name fnt
19012 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19013 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19014 7 bytes_read* 212
19015 8 termination_state --
19016 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19017 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19018
19019Detailed fields description :
19020 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019021 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19022 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19023 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019024 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019025 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019026 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019027
19028 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019029 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19030 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19031 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019032
19033 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19034 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19035 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019036 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19037 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19038 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19039 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019040
19041 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19042 and processed the connection.
19043
19044 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19045 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19046 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19047 applications.
19048
19049 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19050 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19051 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19052 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19053 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19054
19055 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19056 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19057 See "Timers" below for more details.
19058
19059 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19060 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19061 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19062 "Timers" below for more details.
19063
19064 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019065 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019066 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19067 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19068 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19069 details.
19070
19071 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19072 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19073 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19074 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19075 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19076
19077 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19078 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19079 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19080 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19081 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19082 for more details.
19083
19084 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019085 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019086 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19087 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19088 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019089 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019090
19091 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19092 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19093 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19094 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19095 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19096 caused by a denial of service attack.
19097
19098 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19099 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19100 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19101 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19102 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19103 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19104 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19105 denial of service attack.
19106
19107 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19108 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19109 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19110 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19111 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19112 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19113 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19114 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19115 be processed than on other servers.
19116
19117 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19118 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19119 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19120 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19121 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19122 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19123 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19124 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19125 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19126 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19127 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19128 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19129 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19130
19131 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19132 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19133 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19134 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19135 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19136 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019137 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019138 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19139
19140 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19141 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19142 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19143 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19144 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19145 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019146 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019147 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19148 occurs.
19149
19150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191518.2.3. HTTP log format
19152----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153
19154The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19155is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19156the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19157are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19158emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19159generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19160"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19161which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019162frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19163is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019164
19165Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19166slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19167with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19168
19169 Example :
19170 frontend http-in
19171 mode http
19172 option httplog
19173 log global
19174 default_backend bck
19175
19176 backend static
19177 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19178
19179 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19180 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19181 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019182 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019183
19184 Field Format Extract from the example above
19185 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19186 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019187 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019188 4 frontend_name http-in
19189 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019190 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019191 7 status_code 200
19192 8 bytes_read* 2750
19193 9 captured_request_cookie -
19194 10 captured_response_cookie -
19195 11 termination_state ----
19196 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19197 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19198 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19199 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19200 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019201
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019202Detailed fields description :
19203 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019204 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19205 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19206 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019207 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019208 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019209 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019210
19211 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019212 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19213 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19214 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019215
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019216 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19217 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019218
19219 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19220 and processed the connection.
19221
19222 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19223 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19224 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19225
19226 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19227 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19228 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19229 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19230 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19231 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19232
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019233 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19234 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19235 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019236 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019237 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19238 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019239 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19240 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019241
19242 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19243 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019244 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19247 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019248 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19249 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019250
19251 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19252 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19253 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19254 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19255 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019256 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19257 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019258
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019259 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19260 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19261 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19262 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19263 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19264 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19265 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019266 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019267
19268 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19269 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19270 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19271
19272 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19273 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019274 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019275 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19276 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19277 overflowing.
19278
19279 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19280 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19281 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19282 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19283 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19284 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19285 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19286 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19287
19288 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19289 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19290 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19291 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19292 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19293 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19294 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19295 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19296
19297 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19298 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19299 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19300 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19301 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19302 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19303 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19304
19305 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019306 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019307 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19308 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19309 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019310 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019311 system.
19312
19313 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19314 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19315 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19316 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19317 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19318 caused by a denial of service attack.
19319
19320 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19321 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19322 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19323 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19324 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19325 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19326 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19327 denial of service attack.
19328
19329 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19330 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19331 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19332 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19333 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19334 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19335 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19336 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19337 processed than on other servers.
19338
19339 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19340 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19341 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19342 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19343 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19344 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19345 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19346 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19347 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19348 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19349 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19350 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19351 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19352
19353 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19354 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19355 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19356 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19357 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19358 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019359 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019360 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19361
19362 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19363 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19364 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19365 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19366 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19367 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019368 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019369 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19370 occurs.
19371
19372 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19373 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19374 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19375 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19376 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19377 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19378 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19379 cookies" below for more details.
19380
19381 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19382 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19383 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19384 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19385 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19386 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19387 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19388 and cookies" below for more details.
19389
19390 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19391 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19392 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19393 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19394 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19395 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19396 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19397 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19398
19399
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200194008.2.4. Custom log format
19401------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019402
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019403The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019404mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019405
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019406HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019407Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19408separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19409prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19410
19411Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19412variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019413("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019414
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019415If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019416as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019417less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19418the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19419
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019420Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19421"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19422delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19423preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019424
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019425Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19426'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19427https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19428such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19429
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019430Flags are :
19431 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019432 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019433 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19434 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019435
19436 Example:
19437
19438 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19439 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19440
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019441 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19442
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019443At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019445 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19446 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019447
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019448the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019449
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019450 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19451 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19452 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019453
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019454and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19455
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019456 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19457 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019458
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019459Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19460
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019461 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019462 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019463 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19464 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19465 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019466 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19467 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19468 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019469 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019470 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdebf9f0f942020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019471 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019472 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019473 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19474 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019475 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019476 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019477 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019478 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019479 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019480 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019481 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019482 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19483 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19484 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19485 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19486 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019487 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019488 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019489 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019490 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019491 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019492 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19493 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019494 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19495 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19496 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019497 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019498 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19499 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019500 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019501 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19502 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19503 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019504 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019505 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019506 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19507 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19508 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19509 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019510 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019511 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019512 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019513 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019514 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019515 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019516 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19517 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19518 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019519 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019520 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19521 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019522 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019523 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19524 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019525 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019526 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019527 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019528 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019529
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019530 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019531
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019532
195338.2.5. Error log format
19534-----------------------
19535
19536When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19537protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19538By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19539"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019540will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019541logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19542
19543The format looks like this :
19544
19545 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19546 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19547 Connection error during SSL handshake
19548
19549 Field Format Extract from the example above
19550 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19551 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19552 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19553 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19554 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19555
19556These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19557failures.
19558
19559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195608.3. Advanced logging options
19561-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019562
19563Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19564just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19565options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19566for more information about their usage.
19567
19568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195698.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19570------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019571
19572It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19573haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19574commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19575monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19576ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19577
19578 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19579 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19580 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19581 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19582
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019583 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19584 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019585
19586 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19587 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19588 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19589
19590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195918.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19592----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019593
19594The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19595what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19596or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019597"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019598just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19599log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19600after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19601is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19602with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19603with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19604
19605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19607------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019608
19609Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19610for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19611"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19612retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19613raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19614a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19615file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19616you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19617"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19618
19619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196208.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19621--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019622
19623Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19624multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19625them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19626"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19627logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19628error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19629and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19630too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19631useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19632alternative.
19633
19634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196358.4. Timing events
19636------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019637
19638Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19639reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19640the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19641frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019642mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19643addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19644
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019645Timings events in HTTP mode:
19646
19647 first request 2nd request
19648 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19649 t tr t tr ...
19650 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19651 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19652 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19653 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019654 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019655 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19656
19657Timings events in TCP mode:
19658
19659 TCP session
19660 |<----------------->|
19661 t t
19662 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19663 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19664 |<------ Tt ------->|
19665
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019666 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019667 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019668 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19669 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19670 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019671 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019672 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19673 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19674 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19675 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019676
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019677 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19678 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19679 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019680 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19681 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19682 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19683 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19684 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19685 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019686
19687 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19688 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19689 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19690 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19691 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19692 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19693 request typed by hand during a test.
19694
19695 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19696 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019697 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019698 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19699 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19700 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19701 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019702
19703 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19704 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19705 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19706 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19707 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19708
19709 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19710 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19711 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19712 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19713 connection never established.
19714
19715 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19716 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19717 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19718 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19719 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19720 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19721 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19722 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19723 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19724 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19725 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019727 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19728 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19729 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19730 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19731 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19732 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19733
19734 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19735
19736 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19737 "Ta" can never be negative.
19738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019739 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19740 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019741 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19742 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019743 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019744
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019745 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019746
19747 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019748 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19749 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019750
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019751 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19752 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19753 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19754 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19755 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19756 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19757 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19758 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019760These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19761protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19762that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019763due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19764"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19765that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019766
19767Most common cases :
19768
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019769 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19770 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19771 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19772 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19773 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19774 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19775 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19776 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19777 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19778 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19779 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019780 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019781
19782 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19783 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19784 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19785 of ms on remote networks.
19786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019787 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19788 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19789 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019791 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19792 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19793 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19794 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19795 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19796 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19797 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19798 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19799 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019800
19801Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19802
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019803 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019804 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019805 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019807 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019808 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19809 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19810
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019811 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019812 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19813 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19814 flags.
19815
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019816 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19817 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019818 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19819 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19820 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19821 the client connection was maintained open.
19822
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019823 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019824 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019825 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019826 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19827
19828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198298.5. Session state at disconnection
19830-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019831
19832TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19833"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
198342-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19835each of which has a special meaning :
19836
19837 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19838 session to terminate :
19839
19840 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19841
19842 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19843 server explicitly refused it.
19844
19845 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19846 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19847 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19848 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019849 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019850
19851 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19852 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019853
19854 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19855 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19856 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19857 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19858 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19859
19860 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19861 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19862 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19863 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19864 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19865
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019866 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19867 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19868
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019869 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19870 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19871 backup connections when going up.
19872
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019873 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019875 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19876 send or receive data.
19877
19878 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19879 send or receive data.
19880
19881 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19882 with nothing left in the buffers.
19883
19884 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19885
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019886 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019887 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19888
19889 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19890 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19891 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19892 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19893 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19894
19895 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19896 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19897
19898 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19899 server (HTTP only).
19900
19901 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19902
19903 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19904 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19905 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19906
19907 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19908 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19909 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19910
19911 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19912
19913 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19914 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19915
19916 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19917 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19918 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19919
19920 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19921 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019922 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19923 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019924
19925 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19926 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19927 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19928 another server.
19929
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019930 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019931 server.
19932
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019933 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19934 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19935 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19936 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19937
19938 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19939 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19940 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19941 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19942
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019943 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19944 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19945 "use-server" rule).
19946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019947 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19948
19949 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19950 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19951
19952 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19953
19954 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19955 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19956 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19957
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019958 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19959 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019960 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019961 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19962 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19963
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19965
19966 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19967 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19968
19969 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19970
19971 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19972
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019973The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19974was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019975helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19976starvation, attacks, etc...
19977
19978The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19979alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19980easier finding and understanding.
19981
19982 Flags Reason
19983
19984 -- Normal termination.
19985
19986 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19987 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19988 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19989 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19990
19991 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19992 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19993 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19994 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19995 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19996 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019997
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019998 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19999 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020000 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020001
20002 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20003 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20004 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20005
20006 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20007 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20008 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20009 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20010 the server takes too long to respond.
20011
20012 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20013 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20014 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20015 long a time to respond.
20016
20017 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20018 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20019 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20020 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020021 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20022 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020023
20024 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20025 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20026 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20027 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20028 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020029 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020030 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20031 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20032 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20033 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20034 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20035 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20036 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20037 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020038 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020039 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20040 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20041 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042
20043 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20044 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020045 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20046 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20047 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20048 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020049
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020050 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20051 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020053 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020054 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20055 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020056 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20058 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20059
20060 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20061 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20062 503 or 504 here.
20063
20064 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20065 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20066 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20067 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20068 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20069
20070 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20071 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020072 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20074 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20075
20076 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20077 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20078 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20079 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20080 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20081 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20082 between haproxy and the server.
20083
20084 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20085 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20086 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20087 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20088 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20089 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20090 solution is to fix the application.
20091
20092 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20093 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20094 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20095 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20096 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20097 external attacks.
20098
20099 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20100 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020101 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020102 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20103 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20104
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020105 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20106 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20107 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020108 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020109 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020110
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020111 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20112 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20113 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20114 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020115 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20116 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20117 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20118 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20119 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020120
20121 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20122 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20123 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20124 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20125
20126 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20127 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20128 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20129 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20130
20131 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20132 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20133 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20134 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020136The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20137persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20138important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20139re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20140
20141 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20142
20143 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20144 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20145 set on a GET request.
20146
20147 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20148 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020149 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020150 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20151
20152 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20153 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20154 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20155
20156 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20157 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20158 already got a cookie.
20159
20160 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20161 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20162 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20163 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20164 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20165
20166 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20167 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20168 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20169
20170 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20171 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20172 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20173
20174 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20175 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20176
20177 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20178 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20179 then advertised in the response.
20180
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201828.6. Non-printable characters
20183-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020184
20185In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20186consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20187converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20188prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20189being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20190escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20191is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20192'}' when logging headers.
20193
20194Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20195issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20196containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20197
20198Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20199the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20200performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20201
20202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20204---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205
20206Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20207achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020208section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020209cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20210the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20211the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020212locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020213not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20214user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20215a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20216wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20217
20218 Examples :
20219 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20220 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20221
20222 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20223 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20224
20225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202268.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20227---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228
20229Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20230proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20231the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20232server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20233
20234Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20235response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020236section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020237
20238It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020239time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20240appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020241are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20242and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20243follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20244request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20245in the logs.
20246
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020247As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20248frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20249an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20250
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020251 Example :
20252 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20253 listen proxy-out
20254 mode http
20255 option httplog
20256 option logasap
20257 log global
20258 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20259
20260 # log the name of the virtual server
20261 capture request header Host len 20
20262
20263 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20264 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20265
20266 # log the beginning of the referrer
20267 capture request header Referer len 20
20268
20269 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20270 capture response header Server len 20
20271
20272 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20273 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020275 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020276 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20277
20278 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20279 capture response header Via len 20
20280
20281 # log the URL location during a redirection
20282 capture response header Location len 20
20283
20284 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20285 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20286 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20287 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20288 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20289
20290 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20291 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20292 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20293 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020294 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020295
20296 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20297 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20298 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20299 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20300 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020301 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020302
20303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203048.9. Examples of logs
20305---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020306
20307These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20308them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20309reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20310
20311 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20312 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20313 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20314
20315 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20316 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20317
20318 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20319 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20320 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20321
20322 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20323 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20324
20325 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20326 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20327 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20328
20329 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020330 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020331 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20332 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20333
20334 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20335 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20336 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20337
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020338 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20339 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20340 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20341 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20342 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20343 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020344
20345 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020346 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
20348 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20349 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20350 Nothing was sent to any server.
20351
20352 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20353 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20354
20355 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20356 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020357 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358 send a 408 return code to the client.
20359
20360 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20361 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20362
20363 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20364 5 seconds ("c----").
20365
20366 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20367 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020368 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020369
20370 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020371 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20373 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20374 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20375 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20376 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020377
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020378
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200203799. Supported filters
20380--------------------
20381
20382Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20383accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20384unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20385
20386See also : "filter"
20387
203889.1. Trace
20389----------
20390
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020391filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020392
20393 Arguments:
20394 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20395 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20396
20397 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20398 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20399 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20400 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020402 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020403 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20404 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20405 amount of the parsed data.
20406
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020407 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020408
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020409This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20410callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20411information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20412filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20413
20414Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20415tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20416a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20417
20418
204199.2. HTTP compression
20420---------------------
20421
20422filter compression
20423
20424The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20425keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020426when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20427fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20428done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20429explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20430filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20431listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20432order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020433
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020434See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20435 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020436
20437
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200204389.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20439--------------------------------------------
20440
20441filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20442
20443 Arguments :
20444
20445 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20446 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20447 parsed.
20448
20449 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20450 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20451 part must be placed in its own scope.
20452
20453The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20454external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020455streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020456exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20457also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20458
20459SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20460the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20461
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020462For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020463"doc/SPOE.txt".
20464
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100204659.4. Cache
20466----------
20467
20468filter cache <name>
20469
20470 Arguments :
20471
20472 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20473
20474The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20475"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020476cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020477other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20478case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20479is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20480filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020481listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20482order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020483
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020484See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20485 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20486
20487
204889.5. Fcgi-app
20489-------------
20490
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020491filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020492
20493 Arguments :
20494
20495 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20496
20497The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20498request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20499reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20500used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20501implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20502used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20503fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20504used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20505order.
20506
20507See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20508 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20509
20510
2051110. FastCGI applications
20512-------------------------
20513
20514HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20515feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20516the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20517FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20518servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20519FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20520backend.
20521
20522HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20523application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20524connection.
20525
2052610.1. Setup
20527-----------
20528
2052910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20530--------------------------
20531
20532fcgi-app <name>
20533 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20534 document root must be defined.
20535
20536acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20537 Declare or complete an access list.
20538
20539 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20540 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20541 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20542 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20543 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20544
20545docroot <path>
20546 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20547 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20548 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20549
20550index <script-name>
20551 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20552 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20553 is an optional setting.
20554
20555 Example :
20556 index index.php
20557
20558log-stderr global
20559log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20560 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20561 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20562
20563 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20564 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20565
20566pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20567 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20568 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20569 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20570
20571 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20572 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20573 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20574 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20575
20576 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20577 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20578
20579path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020580 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020581 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20582 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20583 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20584 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20585 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20586 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20587 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020588
20589 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020590 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020591 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20592 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20593 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20594 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020595
20596 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020597 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20598 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020599
20600option get-values
20601no option get-values
20602 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20603
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020604 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020605 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20606
20607 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20608 application will accept.
20609
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020610 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20611 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020612
20613 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020614 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020615 option is disabled.
20616
20617 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20618 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20619 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20620 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20621 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20622 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20623
20624option keep-conn
20625no option keep-conn
20626 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20627 sending a response.
20628
20629 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20630 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20631
20632option max-reqs <reqs>
20633 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20634 accept.
20635
20636 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20637 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20638 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20639 to 1.
20640
20641option mpxs-conns
20642no option mpxs-conns
20643 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20644
20645 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20646 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20647
20648set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20649 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20650 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20651 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20652 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20653
20654 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20655 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20656 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20657
20658 Example :
20659 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20660 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20661
20662 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20663
20664
2066510.1.2. Proxy section
20666---------------------
20667
20668use-fcgi-app <name>
20669 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20670
20671 Arguments :
20672 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20673
20674 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20675 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20676 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20677 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20678 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20679
20680 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20681 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20682 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20683 application are evaluated.
20684
20685
2068610.1.3. Example
20687---------------
20688
20689 frontend front-http
20690 mode http
20691 bind *:80
20692 bind *:
20693
20694 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20695 default_backend back-static
20696
20697 backend back-static
20698 mode http
20699 server www A.B.C.D:80
20700
20701 backend back-dynamic
20702 mode http
20703 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20704 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20705
20706 fcgi-app php-fpm
20707 log-stderr global
20708 option keep-conn
20709
20710 docroot /var/www/my-app
20711 index index.php
20712 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20713
20714
2071510.2. Default parameters
20716------------------------
20717
20718A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20719the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020720script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020721applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20722
20723 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20724 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20725 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20726 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20727 | | |
20728 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20729 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20730 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20731 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20732 | | application. |
20733 | | |
20734 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20735 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20736 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20737 | | |
20738 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20739 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20740 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20741 | | the application's configuration. |
20742 | | |
20743 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20744 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20745 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20746 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20747 | | |
20748 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20749 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20750 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20751 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20752 | | be defined. |
20753 | | |
20754 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20755 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20756 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20757 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20758 | | is not set too. |
20759 | | |
20760 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20761 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20762 | | set. |
20763 | | |
20764 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20765 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20766 | | the request. |
20767 | | |
20768 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20769 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20770 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20771 | | |
20772 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20773 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20774 | | script to process the request. |
20775 | | |
20776 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20777 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20778 | | |
20779 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20780 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20781 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20782 | | |
20783 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20784 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20785 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20786 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20787 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20788 | | |
20789 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20790 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20791 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20792 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20793 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20794 | | side. |
20795 | | |
20796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20797 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20798 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20799 | | connected to. |
20800 | | |
20801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20802 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20803 | | |
20804 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20805 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20806 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20807 | | |
20808 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20809
20810
2081110.3. Limitations
20812------------------
20813
20814The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20815way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20816during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20817establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20818application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20819or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20820message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20821these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20822and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20823
20824Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20825request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20826requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20827
20828About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20829into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20830fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20831"http-request" ones.
20832
20833Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20834FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20835processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20836must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20837here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020838
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020839/*
20840 * Local variables:
20841 * fill-column: 79
20842 * End:
20843 */